SEAOC Seismic Design Manual Examples Vol 3 PDF
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual Examples Vol 3 PDF
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual Examples Vol 3 PDF
Manual
Volume III
Building Design Examples:
Steel, Concrete and Cladding
November 2000
Copyright
Copyright 2000 Structural Engineers Association of California. All rights reserved. This
publication or any part thereof must not be reproduced in any form without the written
permission of the Structural Engineers Association of California.
Publisher
Structural Engineers Association of California (SEAOC)
1730 I Street, Suite 240
Sacramento, California 95814-3017
Telephone: (916) 447-1198; Fax: (916) 443-8065
E-mail: [email protected]; Web address: http://www.seaoc.org/
The Structural Engineers Association of California (SEAOC) is a professional association
of four regional member organizations (Central California, Northern California, San
Diego, and Southern California). SEAOC represents the structural engineering community
in California. This document is published in keeping with SEAOCs stated mission: to
advance the structural engineering profession, to provide the public with structures of
dependable performance through the application of state-of-the-art structural engineering
principles; to assist the public in obtaining professional structural engineering services; to
promote natural hazard mitigation; to provide continuing education and encourage
research; to provide structural engineers with the most current information and tools to
improve their practice; and to maintain the honor and dignity of the profession.
Editor: Gail Hynes Shea, Albany, California. Cover photos, clockwise from upper right:
900 E. Hamilton Ave. Office Complex, Campbell, Calif.Joe Maffei, Rutherford &
Chekene; Clark Pacific; SCBF connectionBuehler & Buehler; UBC; RBS Dog Bone
connectionBuehler & Buehler.
Disclaimer
Practice documents produced by the Structural Engineers Association of California
(SEAOC), and all narrative texts, drawings, calculations, and other information herein,
are published as part of SEAOCs educational program. The material presented in this
publication is intended for educational purposes only; it should not be used or relied on
for any specific application without the competent examination and verification of its
accuracy, suitability, and applicability to a specific project by a qualified structural
engineer. While the information presented in this publication is believed to be correct,
neither SEAOC nor its member organizations, committees, writers, editors, individuals,
or entities which have in any way contributed to it make any warranty, express or
implied, or assume any legal liability or responsibility for the use, application of and/or
reference to the text, drawings, calculations, samples, references, opinions, findings,
conclusions, or recommendations included in this publication. Users of this publication
and its contents assume all liability arising from such use.
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Preface ............................................................................................................................... v
Acknowledgements .............................................................................................................vi
Introduction ......................................................................................................................... 1
How to Use This Document ................................................................................................ 3
Notation ............................................................................................................................... 4
Design Example 1
1A Special Concentric Braced Frame ....................................................................... 19
1B Ordinary Concentric Braced Frame ..................................................................... 67
1C Chevron Braced Frame........................................................................................ 77
Design Example 2
Eccentric Braced Frame ............................................................................................. 89
Design Example 3
3A Steel Special Moment Resisting Frame............................................................. 143
3B Steel Ordinary Moment Resisting Frame........................................................... 189
Design Example 4
Reinforced Concrete Wall......................................................................................... 209
Design Example 5
Reinforced Concrete Wall with Coupling Beams...................................................... 237
Design Example 6
Concrete Special Moment Resisting Frame............................................................. 271
Design Example 7
Precast Concrete Cladding....................................................................................... 313
iii
iv
Preface
Preface
This document is the third volume of the three-volume SEAOC Seismic Design Manual.
The first volume, Code Application Examples, was published in April 1999. The second
volume, Building Design Examples: Light Frame, Masonry and Tilt-up was published in
April 2000. These documents have been developed by the Structural Engineers
Association of California (SEAOC) with funding provided by SEAOC. Their purpose is
to provide guidance on the interpretation and use of the seismic requirements in the 1997
Uniform Building Code (UBC), published by the International Conference of Building
Officials (ICBO), and in SEAOCs 1999 Recommended Lateral Force Requirements and
Commentary (also called the Blue Book).
The Seismic Design Manual was developed to fill a void that exists between the
Commentary of the Blue Book, which explains the basis for the UBC seismic provisions,
and everyday structural engineering design practice. While the Seismic Design Manual
illustrates how the provisions of the code are used, the examples shown do not
necessarily illustrate the only appropriate methods of seismic design, and the document
is not intended to establish a minimum standard of care. Engineering judgment must be
exercised when applying these Design Examples to real projects.
Volume I: Code Application Examples, provides step-by-step examples of how to use
individual code provisions, such as how to compute base shear or building period.
Volumes II and III: Design Examples furnish examples of the seismic design of common
types of buildings. In Volumes II and III, important aspects of whole buildings are
designed to show, calculation-by-calculation, how the various seismic requirements of
the code are implemented in a realistic design.
Volume III contains ten examples. These illustrate the seismic design of the following
structures:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
It is SEAOCs present intention to update the Seismic Design Manual with each edition
of the building code used in California. Work is presently underway on an 2000
International Building Code version.
Ronald P. Gallagher
Project Manager
Acknowledgments
Acknowledgments
Authors
The Seismic Design Manual was written by a group of highly qualified structural
engineers. These individuals are California registered civil and structural engineers
and SEAOC members. They were selected by a Steering Committee set up by the
SEAOC Board of Directors and were chosen for their knowledge and experience
with structural engineering practice and seismic design. The Consultants for
Volumes I, II and III are:
Ronald P. Gallagher, Project Manager
Robert Clark
David A. Hutchinson
Jon P. Kiland
John W. Lawson
Joseph R. Maffei
Douglas S. Thompson
Theodore C. Zsutty
Volume III was written principally by David A. Hutchinson (Design Examples 1A,
1B and 1C, and 3A and 3B), Jon P. Kiland (Design Examples 2 and 6), Joseph R.
Maffei (Design Examples 4 and 5), and Robert Clark (Design Example 7). Many
useful ideas and helpful suggestions were offered by the other consultants.
Steering Committee
Overseeing the development of the Seismic Design Manual and the work of the
Consultants was the Project Steering Committee. The Steering Committee was
made up of senior members of SEAOC who are both practicing structural
engineers and have been active in Association leadership. Members of the Steering
Committee attended meetings and took an active role in shaping and reviewing the
document. The Steering Committee consisted of:
John G. Shipp, Chair
Robert N. Chittenden
Stephen K. Harris
Martin W. Johnson
Scott A. Stedman
vi
Reviewers
Reviewers
A number of SEAOC members, and other structural engineers, helped check the
examples in Volume III. During its development, drafts of the examples were sent
to these individuals. Their help was sought in both review of code interpretations as
well as detailed checking of the numerical computations. The assistance of the
following individuals is gratefully acknowledged:
Vin Balachandran
Raymond Bligh
Dirk Bondy
David Bonowitz
Robert Chittenden
Michael Cochran
Anthony Court
Juan Carlos Esquival
Brent Forslin
S. K. Ghosh
Jeff Guh
Ronald Hamburger
Douglas Hohbach
Dominic Kelly
Edward Knowles
Kenneth Lutrell
Robert Lyons
Peter Maranian
Seismology Committee
Close collaboration with the SEAOC Seismology Committee was maintained
during the development of the document. The 1999-2000 Committee reviewed the
document and provided many helpful comments and suggestions. Their assistance
is gratefully acknowledged.
1999-2000
H. John Khadivi
Jaiteeerth B. Kinhal
Robert Lyons
Simin Naaseh
Chris V. Tokas
Michael Riley, Assistant to the Chair
vii
Errata Notification
SEAOC has made a substantial effort to ensure that the information in this
document is accurate. In the event that corrections or clarifications are needed,
these will be posted on the SEAOC web site at http://www.seaoc.org or on the
ICBO website at http://ww.icbo.org. SEAOC, at its sole discretion, may or may not
issue written errata.
viii
Seismic Design
Manual
Volume III
Building Design Examples:
Steel, Concrete and Cladding
Introduction
Introduction
Seismic design of new steel and concrete buildings, and precast cladding, for the
requirements of the 1997 Uniform Building Code (UBC) is illustrated in this
document. Ten examples are shown:
1A
1B
1C
2
3A
3B
4
5
6
7
The buildings selected are for the most part representative of construction types
found in Zones 3 and 4, particularly California and the western states. Designs
have been largely taken from real world buildings, although some simplifications
were necessary for purposes of illustrating significant points and not presenting
repetitive or unnecessarily complicated aspects of a design.
The Design Examples are not complete building designs, or even complete
seismic designs, but rather they are examples of the significant seismic design
aspects of a particular type of building.
In developing these Design Examples, SEAOC has endeavored to illustrate
correct use of the minimum provisions of the code. The document is intended to
help the reader understand and correctly use the design provisions of UBC
Chapter 16 (Design Requirements), Chapter 19 (Concrete), and Chapter 22
(Steel). Design practices of an individual structural engineer or office, which may
result in a more seismic-resistant design than required by the minimum
requirements of UBC, are not given. When appropriate, however, these
considerations are discussed as alternatives.
In some examples, the performance characteristics of the structural system are
discussed. This typically includes a brief review of the past earthquake behavior
and mention of design improvements added to recent codes. SEAOC believes it is
essential that structural engineers not only know how to correctly interpret and
Introduction
apply the provisions of the code, but that they also understand their basis. For this
reason, many examples have commentary included on past earthquake
performance.
While the Seismic Design Manual is based on the 1997 UBC, references are made
to the provisions of SEAOCs 1999 Recommended Lateral Force Provisions and
Commentary (Blue Book). When differences between the UBC and Blue Book are
significant, these are brought to the attention of the reader.
AISC-Seismic 15.3b
SEAOC C402.8
Notation
Notation
The following notations are used in this document. These are generally consistent
with that used in the UBC and other codes such as ACI and AISC. Some additional
notations have also been added. The reader is cautioned that the same notation may
be used more than once and may carry entirely different meaning in different
situations. For example, E can mean the tabulated elastic modulus under the AISC
definition (steel) or it can mean the earthquake load under 1630.1 of the UBC
(loads). When the same notation is used in two or more definitions, each definition
is prefaced with a brief description in parentheses (e.g., steel or loads) before the
definition is given.
AB
ABM
Ab
Ac
Ach
Acv
Ae
Af
flange area
Ag
Ap
As
Notation
Ash
Ask
As,min
Ast
Av
Avd
Avf
Aw
Aw
Ax
ac
ap
bf
flange width
bw
web width
b/t
Ca
Notation
Ce
Cq
Ct
Cv
Cm
De
db
db
dz
EI
Ec
Es
Fa
Fb
FBM
Notation
FEXX
Fp
Fu
Fw
Fw
Fy
Fyb
Fy of a beam
Fyc
Fy of a column
Fye
Fyf
Fy of column flange
Fyh
Fyw
fa
fb
f c'
fct
fut
F' e
23(Kb / rb )2
fi
fm'
fp
12 2 E
Notation
fr
Ftt
fy
f x, f y, f r =
g
hc
hc
he
hi, hn,hx =
hr
hw
Icr
Ig
Ig
Ip
Ise
Notation
It
Iw
Lp
lc
lc
lh
ln
lu
lw
Level i =
Level n =
Level x =
Mc
Notation
Mcl
Mcr
10
Mf
Mm
Mm
Mn
Mp
Mp
Mpa
Mpe
Mpr
Mpr
Ms
Ms
Mu
Mu
My
Notation
M1
M2
Na
Nv
Pb
Pbf
Pc
Pc
Pe
Pn
Po
Psc
1.7 Fa A
Psc,Pst =
Psi
11
Notation
12
Pu
Pu
Pu
Py
PDL
PE
PLL
qs
Rn
nominal strength
Rnw
Rp
Ru
required strength
Ry
ry
Notation
SA, SB, SC, SD, SE, S F = soil profile types as set forth in Table 16-J
SRBS
tf
thickness of flange
tw
thickness of web
tz
Vc
Vc
Vn
Vp
Vpa
Vs
Vs
Vu
Vu
Vu
13
Notation
Vu
Vu *
Vx
Wp
wc
wi, wx =
14
wpx
wz
ZRBS
Notation
ratio of volume of spiral reinforcement to total volume of core (outto-out of spirals) of a spirally reinforced compression member
15
Notation
16
la
length of radius cut in beam flange for reduced beam section (RBS)
connection design
lh
ln
lu
lw
coefficient of friction
References
References
ACI-318, 1995. American Concrete Institute, Building Code Regulations for
Reinforced Concrete, Farmington Hills, Michigan.
AISC-ASD, 1989. American Institute of Steel Construction, Manual of Steel
Construction, Allowable Stress Design, Chicago, Illinois, 9th Edition.
AISC-LRFD, 1994. American Institute of Steel Construction, Manual of Steel
Construction, Load and Resistance Factor Design, Chicago, Illinois, 2nd
Edition.
AISC-Seismic. Seismic Provisions for Structural Steel Buildings, American Institute
of Steel Construction, Chicago, Illinois, April 15, 1997 and Supplement No. 1,
February 15, 1999.
SEAOC Blue Book, 1999. Recommended Lateral Force Requirements and
Commentary, Structural Engineers Association of California, Sacramento,
California.
UBC, 1997. International Conference of Building Officials, Uniform Building Code,
Whittier, California.
17
18
Design Example 1A
Design Example 1A
Special Concentric Braced Frame
Figure 1A-1. Four-story steel frame office building with special concentric braced frames (SCBF)
Foreword
Design Examples 1A, 1B and 1C show the seismic design of essentially the same
four-story steel frame building using three different concentric bracing systems.
"
"
"
These Design Examples have been selected to aid the reader in understanding
design of different types of concentric braced frame systems. Design of eccentric
braced frames (EBFs) is illustrated in Design Example 2.
19
Design Example 1A
Overview
The 4-story steel frame office structure shown in Figure 1A-1 is to have special
concentric bracing as its lateral force resisting system. The typical floor plan is
shown on Figure 1A-2, and a building section is shown in Figure 1A-3.
Figure 1A-4 depicts a two-story x-brace configuration and elevations. Design of
the major lateral force resisting structural steel elements and connections uses
AISC Allowable Stress Design (ASD).
The 1997 UBC design provisions for special concentric braced frames (SCBFs) are
attributed to research performed at the University of Michigan. The basis for SCBF
bracing is the proportioning of members such that the compression diagonals
buckle in a well behaved manner, without local buckling or kinking that would
result in a permanent plastic deformation of the brace. Research performed has
demonstrated that systems with this ductile buckling behavior perform well under
cyclic loading. Several references are listed at the end of this Design Example.
20
Design Example 1A
Elevation A
Elevation B
21
Design Example 1A
Outline
This Design Example illustrates the following parts of the design process:
1.
2.
3.
Interstory drifts.
4.
5.
6.
Given Information
Roof weights:
Roofing
Insulation
Concrete fill on metal
deck
Ceiling
Mechanical/electrical
Steel framing
Live load:
4.0 psf
3.0
44.0
3.0
5.0
7.0
66.0 psf
20.0 psf
22
Floor weights:
Flooring
Concrete fill on metal deck
Ceiling
Mechanical/electrical
Steel framing
Partitions
Live load:
1.0 psf
44.0
3.0
5.0
9.0
10.0
72.0 psf
80.0 psf
15 psf
Design Example 1A
1629.2
Table 16-K
1629.3, Table 16-J
1629.4.1, Table 16-I
1629.4.2
Table 16-U
Tables 16-S, 16-T
The geotechnical report for the project site should include the seismologic criteria
noted above. If no geotechnical report is forthcoming, ICBO has published Maps of
Known Active Fault Near-Source Zones in California and Adjacent Portions of
Nevada [ICBO, 1998]. These maps (prepared by the California Department of
Conservation Division of Mines and Geology, in cooperation with the Structural
Engineers Association of California) provide a means for easily determining the
seismic source type and distance to the seismic source.
Shown in Figure 1A-5 are various types of concentric braced frames permitted by
the code. Each of these can be design as either an ordinary concentric braced frame
(OCBF) or a special concentric braced frame (SCBF). It should be noted that the
only difference between an SCBF and an OCBF is the connection detailing and
some prescriptive code requirements.
23
Design Example 1A
a. Zipper
b. 2-story-X
c. X-bracing
d. Inverted V
(or chevron)
e. V-bracing
All of the frames shown in Figure 1A-5 are essentialy variations on the chevron
brace, except for the one-story X-brace (Figure 1A-5c). Single diagonal braced
frames are also permissible by the code, but these are heavily penalized since they
must take 100 percent of the force in compression unless multiple single diagonal
braces are provided along the same brace frame line.
Grades of steel used in SCBFs.
SCBF members are typical wide flange sections (ASTM A36, Fy = 36 ksi, or
A572, grade 50, Fy = 50 ksi), tube sections (ASTM A500, grade B, Fy = 46 ksi),
or pipes (ASTM A53, grade B, Fy = 35 ksi).
When designing brace connections, the actual yield strength of the steel needs
to be considered. The AISC-Seismic provisions address this overstrength issue
using the R y factor, which is not addressed by the UBC or considered in this
Design Example. The gusset plate material used in SCBF connections should be of
equal yield strength to the brace member. Since the actual expected yield strength
of most structural sections used as brace members is in excess of 50 ksi, the
strength of the gusset plate material should be at least 50 ksi. High strength steel is
required in order to keep the gusset plate thickness and dimensions to a minimum.
Use of A36 material (as shown in this Design Example) will generally result in
larger connections.
Brace behavior.
Concentric braced frames are classified by the UBC as either ordinary or special.
The title special is given to braced frames meeting certain detailing and design
parameters that enable them to respond to seismic forces with greater ductility. The
Blue Book Commentary is an excellent reference for comparison and discussion of
these two systems.
24
Design Example 1A
Both inverted V-frames and V-frames have shown poor performance during
past earthquakes due to buckling of the brace and flexure of the beam at the
midspan connection instead of truss action, therefore the zipper, 2-story-X and
X-bracing schemes are the preferred configurations.
The SEAOC Blue Book (in Section C704) has gone as far to recommend that
chevron bracing should not be used unless it is in the Zipper or 2 story x
configuration in high seismic zones. The reader is referred to the SEAOC Blue
Book for a further discussion on chevron braces.
Generally, the preferred behavior of bracing is in-plane buckling when fixity is
developed at the end connections and three hinges are required to form prior to
failure of the brace. The problem is that it is difficult to develop this type of fixity
when you are using gusset plate connections which tend to lend themselves to outof-plane buckling of the brace and behave more like a pin connection.
There are limited structural shapes availble that can be oriented such that the
brace will buckle in-plane. The following is a list of such shapes:
1. Hollow structural sections about their weak axis, for example, a TS
6x3x1/2 arranged as shown in Figure 1A-7a (Note: there can be a problem
with shear lag in HSS sections).
2. Double angles with short legs back to back (Figure 1A-7b).
3. Wide flange shapes buckling about their weak axis (Figure 1A-7c).
25
Design Example 1A
y
a. Flat tube (HSS)
y
b. Double angles (SLV)
26
Design Example 1A
buckling perpendicular to
gusset plate (least resistance)
y
x
yield line
(hinge)
x
y
gusset plate
x
x
Plan view
force
yield line
Isometric view
Figure 1A-9. Out-of-plane buckling of the brace; gusset plates resist axial loads
without buckling, but can rotate about the yield line to accommodate the brace buckling
27
Design Example 1A
To ensure that rotation can occur at each end of the brace without creating restraint,
the axis of the yield line must be perpendicular to the axis of the brace.
Another requirement to allow for rotation about the yield line to occur, is a
minimum offset from the end of the brace to the yield line, as shown in
Figure 1A-11. If this distance is too short, there physically is insufficent distance to
accomodate yielding of the gusset plate without fracture. Figure 1A-11 depicts the
minimum offset requirement of the building codes. Due to erection tolerances and
other variables, it is recommended that this design offset not be less than three
times the gusset plate thickness (3t).
2t (min) 4t
(max offset
brace
Beam
28
Design Example 1A
brace
detailed 2t
offset from
yield line
gusset plate
theoretical curved yield
line as gusset attempts
to bend around tip
2t offset
(clamp force)
Beam
Figure 1A-12 (not recommended) depicts what happens when you try to shape the
end of the brace to match the yield line slope. Due to the offset in the end of the
brace, the yield line will attempt to bend around corner of the brace. This creates
several problems, in that it is impossible to bend the plate about a longer curved
line, since the curve creates more stiffness than a shorter straight line between two
points that wants to be the hinge. The end tip of the brace along the upper edge is
generally not stiff enough to cause a straight yield line to bend perpendicular to the
brace axis about the tip end of the brace since there is only one side wall at this
location to apply force to the gusset plate.
29
Design Example 1A
Detailing considerations.
Floor slabs, typically metal deck and concrete topping slab in steel frame buildings,
can cause additional restraint to buckling out-of-plane and must be taken into
account during design.
If the yield line crosses the edge of the gusset plate below the concrete surface,
more restraint occurs, the gusset plate will likely tear along the top of the concrete
surface.
The SCBF connections design details in Design Example 1A have been simplified,
but need to consider the potential restraint that occurs due to the floor deck since it
will impact the gusset plate design. To keep the gusset plate size as small as
possible, the gusset plate should be isolated from the concrete slab so the yield line
can extend below the concrete surface. Figure 1A-13 shows how the gusset plate
could be isolated from restraint caused by the slab. Note that the entire gusset plate
does not have to be isolated, just that area where the yield line occurs. The
compressible material which can be used would be a fire caulk that has the same
required fire rating as the floor system.
compressible material
gusset plate
1"
2t (min) 4t
(max) offset
Plan
brace
gusset plate
yield line 90 degrees
to slope of brace
compressible
material each side
of gusset plate
concrete slab
2" min
Beam
Figure 1A-13. For the yield line to develop in the gusset plate,
the gusset plate must be isolated from the slab
30
Design Example 1A
Because of the critical importance of the connections, the actual field erection of
SCBFs must be carefully inspected. Shop drawings often show erection aids such
as clip angles and erection bolts. These are used to properly center the brace on the
gusset plate. In the case of tube bracing, it is very common to have an erection bolt
hole placed at each end of the brace. Occasionally, erector crews ignore these
erection aids while placing the bracing over the gusset plates and making the
weldments without verifying that the required 2t to 4t offset from the yield line has
been maintained.
The design engineer needs to remember that structural steel is erected using the
shop drawings and that the structural drawings are often not checked, even though
it is common practice to provide some form of general note that states shop
drawings are an erection aid, and structural drawings shall take precedent over the
shop drawings.
The following is a list of items that should be included in the checklist given to the
Special Inspector:
1. Verify that the 2t minimum, 4t maximum offset from the yield line to brace
end is maintained at each end of the brace.
2. Verify that the 1-inch minimum offset from the brace to the edge of the
gusset plate is maintained and that the gusset plate edge slopes are the same
slopes as shown on shop drawings and structural drawings.
3. Verify that the gusset plate yield line has been isolated from the concrete
slab and that is is away from an edge stiffener plates.
31
Design Example 1A
Calculations
Calculations and Discussion
1.
1a.
Code Reference
1630.1
The structure is L-shaped in plan and must be checked for vertical and horizontal
irregularities.
Vertical irregularities. Review Table 16-L.
By observation, the structure has no vertical irregularities; the bracing is consistent
in all stories with no discontinuities or offsets, and the mass is similar at all floor
levels.
Plan irregularities. Review Table 16-M.
The building plan has a re-entrant corner with both projections exceeding 15
percent of the plan dimension, and therefore is designated as having Plan
Irregularity Type 2. Given the shape of the floor plan, the structure is likely to have
Torsional Irregularity Type 1. This condition will be investigated with the
computer model used for structural analysis later in this Design Example.
Plan Irregularity Type 2 triggers special consideration for diaphragm and collector
design, as delineated in 1633.2.9, Items 6 and 7.
1b.
1629.6
The structure is a building frame system with lateral resistance provided by special
concentrically braced frames (SCBFs) (System Type 2.5.a per Table 16-N). The
seismic factors are:
R = 6.4
o = 2.2
hmax = 240 ft
32
Design Example 1A
1c.
1629.8
The static lateral force procedure is permitted for irregular structures not more than
five stories or 65 feet in height (1629.8.3). Although the structure has a plan
irregularity, it is less than 65 feet in height. A dynamic analysis is not required, so
static lateral procedures will be used.
1d.
1629.4.3
1e.
Table 16-Q
Table 16-R
1630.2.2
Per Method A:
T A = C t (hn ) 4 C t = 0.020
3
T A = 0.02(62 )
(30-8)
= 0.44 sec
Per Method B:
From three-dimensional computer model, the periods are:
North-south direction:
TB = 0.66 sec
East-west direction:
TB = 0.66 sec
Maximum value for TB = 1.3 T A = 1.3(0.44) = 0.57 sec
Therefore, upper bound on period governs use T = 0.57 sec
1630.2.2
33
Design Example 1A
1f.
The total design base shear for a given direction is determined from Equation
(30-4). Since the period is the same for both directions, the design base shear for
either direction is:
V =
Cv I
0.69(1.0 )
W =
W = 0.189W
RT
6.4(0.57 )
(30-4)
2.5Ca I
2.5(0.44)(1.0 )
W =
= 0.172W
R
6.4
(30-5)
0.8ZN v I
0.8(0.4 )(1.08)(1.0)
W =
= 0.054W
R
6.4
(30-7)
1g.
1630.1
Section 1630.1.1 specifies earthquake loads. These are E and E m as set forth in
Equations (30-1) and (30-2).
E = E H + E v
(30-1)
Em = o E H
(30-2)
The normal earthquake design load is E . The load E m is the estimated maximum
earthquake force that can be developed in the structure. It is used only when
specifically required, as will be shown later in this Design Example.
Before determining the earthquake forces for design, the reliability/redundancy
factor must be determined.
Reliability/redundancy factor = 2
34
20
rmax Ab
(30-3)
Design Example 1A
1.10
= 0.061
18
1630.1.1
and:
= 2
20
0.061(90,720 )1 / 2
= 0.91
and:
1.0 1.5
Use = 1.0
The value for should be confirmed upon completion of the computer analysis for
the brace forces.
For load combinations of 1612, E and E m are as follows:
E = E h + E v = 1.0(V )
(30-1)
(30-2)
Note that seismic forces may be assumed to act non-concurrently in each principal
direction of the structure, except as per 1633.1.
2.
2a.
Calculated building weights and centers of gravity at each level are given in
Table 1A-1. Included is an additional 450 kips (5.0 psf) at the roof level for
mechanical equipment. Building mass properties are summarized in Table 1A-2.
Braced frame locations are noted in Figure 1A-14 below.
35
Design Example 1A
w DL
(psf)
71
71
71
15
Area
(sf)
23,760
32,400
34,560
16,416
Wi
(kips)
1,687
2,300
2,454
246
6,687
Ycg
W X cg
(ft)
90
90
276
168
(ft)
66
222
222
175
(lbs)
151,826
207,036
677,238
41,368
1,077,468
I
II
III
Walls
Totals
( )
W Ycg
(lbs)
111,339
510,689
544,735
43,092
1,209,855
( )
X cg
w DL
(psf)
72
72
72
15
Area
(sf)
23,760
32,400
34,560
20,520
Wi
(kips)
1,711
2,333
2,488
308
6,840
X cg
Ycg
(ft)
90
90
276
168
(ft)
66
222
222
175
( )
W X cg
(lbs)
153,965
209,952
686,776
51,710
1,102,404
( )
W Ycg
(lbs)
112,908
517,882
552,407
53,865
1,237,061
Note:
1. Roof weight: wDL = 66.0 + 5.0add'l mech = 71.0 psf ; exterior walls: wwall = 15 psf ;
wall area = (7.5 + 4.5)(1,368 ft ) = 16,416 ft 2
2. wDL = 72.0 psf ; exterior walls: wwall = 15 psf ; wall area = (15)(1,368 ft ) = 20,520 ft 2
36
Design Example 1A
WDL
(kips)
6,687
6,840
6,840
6,840
27,207
(1)
X cg
Ycg
(ft)
(ft)
161.1
161.1
161.1
161.1
180.9
180.9
180.9
180.9
M (2)
MMI (3)
17.3
17.7
17.7
17.7
70.4
316,931
324,183
324,183
324,183
Notes:
1. Mass (M) and mass moment of inertia (MMI) are used in analysis for
determination of fundamental period (T).
2. M = (W 3.86.4 )(kip sec in.)
)(
2b.
As noted above, Equation (30-5) governs, and design base shear is:
V = 0.172W = 0.172(27207) = 4,680 kips
2c.
1630.5
For the static lateral force procedure, vertical distribution of force to each
level is applied as follows:
V = Ft + Fi
(30-13)
where:
Ft = 0.07T (V )
Except Ft = 0 where T 0.7 sec
(30-14)
(V Ft )W x hx
Wi hi
W h
= V x x
Wi hi
(30-15)
37
Design Example 1A
The vertical distribution of force to each level is given in Table 1A-3 below.
Table 1A-3. Distribution of base shear
2d.
Level
wx
(kips)
hx
(ft)
Roof
4th
3rd
2nd
Total
6,687
6,840
6,840
6,840
27,207
62
47
32
17
w x hx
(k-ft)
414,594
321,480
218,880
116,280
1,071,234
w x hx
w x hx
0.39
0.30
0.20
0.11
1.00
Fx
(kips)
1,811.3
1,404.5
956.2
508.0
4,680.0
(kips)
1,811.3
3,215.8
4,172.0
4,680.0
1630.6
Structures with concrete fill floor decks are generally assumed to have rigid
diaphragms. Forces are distributed to the braced frames per their relative rigidities.
In this Design Example, a three-dimensional computer model is used to determine
the distribution of seismic forces to each frame.
For rigid diaphragms, an accidental torsion must be applied (in addition to any
natural torsional moment), as specified in 1630.6. The accidental torsion is equal
to that caused by displacing the center of mass 5 percent of the building dimension
perpendicular to the direction of the applied lateral force.
For our structural computer model, this can be achieved by combining the direct
seismic force applied at the center of mass at each level with the accidental
torsional moment (M z ) at that level.
North-south seismic:
M t = 0.05(372 ft )Fx = (18.6)Fx
East-west seismic:
M t = 0.05(312 ft )Fx = (15.6 )Fx
Using the direct seismic forces and accidental torsional moments given in
Table 1A-4, the distribution of forces to the frames is generated by computer
analysis. (For the computer model, member sizes are initially proportioned by
preliminary hand calculations and then optimized by subsequent iterations.)
38
Design Example 1A
Fx
(kips)
N-S M t
(k-ft)
E-W M t
(k-ft)
Roof
4th
3rd
2nd
1,811.3
1,404.5
956.2
508.0
33,690
26,124
17,785
9,449
28,256
21,910
14,917
7,925
From the computer analysis, forces in each bracing member are totaled to obtain
the seismic force resisted by each frame. The frame forces are then summed and
compare to the seismic base shear for a global equilibrium check. Forces at the
base of each frame are summarized in Table 1A-5 below:
North-South Direction
East-West Direction
Direct Seismic
(kips)
Torsional Force
(kips)
Direct + Torsion
(kips)
A1
A2
A3
A4
B1
Total
1,023
1,067
1,063
1,018
509
4,680
61
65
26
87
12
1,084
1,132
1,089
1,105
521
4,931
977
77
1,054
937
1,005
1,280
481
4,680
76
13
134
6
1,013
1,018
1,414
487
4,986
A5
A6
A7
A8
B2
Total
Note that the torsional seismic component is always additive to the direct seismic
force. Sections 1630.6 and 1630.7 require that the 5 percent center-of-mass
displacement be taken from the calculated center-of-mass, and that the most severe
combination be used for design.
2e.
1630.7
As shown above, the accidental torsional moment has been accounted for as
required by 1630.6. However, we must check for a torsional irregularity (per
Table 16-M, Type 1) to determine if a torsional amplification factor (Ax ) is
required under the provisions of 1630.7.
39
Design Example 1A
Torsional irregularity exists when the drift at one end of the structure exceeds
1.2 times the average drifts at both ends, considering both direct seismic forces
plus accidental torsion. For this evaluation, total seismic displacements at the roof
level are compared. The displacements in Table 1A-6 below are taken from the
computer model for points at the extreme corners of the structure.
@ Line A
0.95 in
@ Line 1
1.05 in
@ Line N
1.3 in
@ Line 11
1.22 in
Average
1.125
Average
1.135
Ratio (max/avg)
1.16 o.k.
Ratio (max/avg)
1.07 o.k.
Because the maximum drift is less than 1.2 times the average drift, no torsional
irregularity exists. The relative displacements at the 2nd, 3rd, and 4th floors are
similar to those at the roof; no torsional irregularities were found to exist at those
levels.
3.
3a.
Interstory drift.
Determine s and m.
1630.9
(30-17)
The greatest calculated values for S and M are to be used, including torsional
effects. For determination of M , P effects must be included. Story drift ratios
are calculated from lateral displacements at each level for both the north-south and
east-west directions (as generated by the computer analysis), and are presented in
the Table 1A-7.
40
Design Example 1A
East-West
Displacements
North-South
Displacements
Height (in.)
S (in.)
M (in.)
4th
180
(1.30-1.04) = 0.26
1.16
0.0064
3rd
180
(1.04-0.70) = 0.34
1.52
0.0084
2nd
180
(0.70-0.34) = 0.36
1.61
0.0089
1st
204
(0.34-0.0) = 0.34
1.52
0.0075
4th
180
(1.22-0.98) = 0.24
1.08
0.0060
3rd
180
(0.98-0.67) = 0.31
1.39
0.0077
2nd
180
(0.67-0.34) = 0.33
1.48
0.0082
1st
204
(0.34-0.0) = 0.34
1.52
0.0075
Notes:
1. Interstory drift ratio = M /story height.
2. Maximum drift occurs at Line N for north-south direction and Line 11 for
east-west direction.
3b.
1630.10
Story drift limits are based on the maximum inelastic response displacements,
M . For structures with T < 0.7 the maximum allowable drift is 0.025 times the
story height. A review of drift ratios tabulated in Table 1A-7 shows that all
interstory drift ratios are less than 0.025 using the period of Equation (30.4).
(Note: Using the full value for TB would result in a lower base shear and smaller
story displacement.)
4.
The building has rigid diaphragms at all levels, including the roof. In this Part,
seismic forces on each diaphragm will be determined, and the roof level diaphragm
designed. The roof was selected because it is the most heavily loaded diaphragm.
4a.
1633.2.9
Ft + Fi
wi
(w px )
(33-1)
where:
0.5C a IW px < F px 1.0C a IW px
1633.2.9 Item 2
41
Design Example 1A
The diaphragm forces at each level, with the upper and lower limits, are calculated
as shown in Table 1A-8.
Table 1A-8. Diaphragm forces (kips)
Level
Fi
Fi
Roof
4th
3rd
2nd
1,811.3
1,404.5
956.2
508.0
1,811.3
3,215.8
4,172.0
4,680.0
wx
6,687
6,840
6,840
6,840
w i
Fpx
0.5Ca Iw px
1.0Ca Iw px
6,687
13,527
20,367
27,207
1,811.3
1,626.1
1,401.1
1,176.6
1,471.1
1,504.8
1,504.8
1,504.8
2,942.3
3,009.6
3,009.6
3,009.6
4b.
The maximum diaphragm design force occurs at the roof level. To facilitate
diaphragm and collector design, this force is divided by the plan area to obtain an
average horizontal seismic force distribution, q roof .
q roof =
1,811
= 0.020 kips/ft 2
90,720
The maximum diaphragm span occurs between Lines A and N, so the north-south
direction will control. Both loading and shear for the roof diaphragm under northsouth seismic forces are shown in Figure 1A-15.
42
Design Example 1A
The computer model assumes rigid diaphragms or load distribution to the frames.
In lieu of an exact analysis, which considers the relative stiffness of the diaphragm
and braced frames, we envelop the solution by next considering the diaphragms
flexible. Shears at each line of resistance are derived assuming the diaphragms
span as simple beam elements under a uniform load.
w1 = q roof (312 ft ) = 0.020(312) = 6.24 kips/ft
Diaphragm shears:
180
V A = VGA = 6.24
= 562 k
2
192
VGN = V N = 3.6
= 346 k
2
To fully envelop the solution, we compare the flexible diaphragm shear at Line N
with the force resisted by Frame A8 (Figure 1A-14) assuming a rigid diaphragm.
From the computer model, we find at Frame A8: Froof = 440 k . The force from the
rigid analysis (440 k) is greater than the force from the flexible analysis (346 k), so
the greater force is used to obtain the maximum diaphragm shear at Line N:
q N = 440 180 = 2.44 k/ft at Line N
1612.3.2
Using allowable stress design and the alternate load combinations of 1612.3.2, the
(12-13) basic load combination is:
E
1.4
(12-13)
o.k.
43
Design Example 1A
Other deck welds (e.g., parallel supports, seam welds) must also be designed for
this loading.
At seismic collectors, it is good practice to place additional welded studs in every
low flute of the deck for shear transfer.
4c.
Using a flexible analysis and assuming diaphragm zone III acts as a simple beam
between Lines G and N (Figure 1A-16), for north-south seismic loads the
maximum chord force on lines 1 and 7 is:
wl 2 3.6(192) 2
CF =
=
= 92.2 kips
8d
8(180)
Note that this value must be compared to the collector force at Lines 1 and 7, and
the largest value used for design.
For structures with plan irregularity type 2, the code disallows the one-third stress
increase for allowable stress design for collector design (1633.2.9, Item 6). This
code section also requires chords and collectors be designed considering
independent movement of the projecting wings, for motion of the wings in both
the same and opposing directions. There are two ways to achieve this:
44
Design Example 1A
1.
2.
w2l 2 3.6(192)2
=
=
= 16,589 kips-ft
8
8
The maximum tie force (TG ) along Lines 1 and 7 at the intersections with Line G
is:
TG = 16,589 180 = 92.2 kips
With allowable diaphragm shear of 75 k/ft, this tie force must be developed back
into diaphragm zone II over a length of at least:
92.2 kips
= 37.6 ft
(1.4)1.75 kips/ft
Next, the collector forces for east-west seismic loads are determined. For Zone III
between Lines 1 and 7, the equivalent uniform lateral load is:
w3 = q (depth ) = 0.020(372 ) = 7.44 k/ft
The collector force at Line 1 is:
R1 = 7.44(180 2) = 670 kips
From the computer model, at the roof level the frames on Line 1 (Frames A1 and
A2) resist loads of 405 kips and 425 kips, respectively.
R1 = 405 A1 + 425 A2 = 830 kips > 670 kips
45
Design Example 1A
Therefore, the rigid diaphragm analysis governs, and the shear flow along Line 1
(q1 ) , is:
q1 = 830 372 = 2.23 kips/ft
As shown in Figure 1A-17, collector forces at points a, b, c, and d are:
Fa = 2.23(30 ) = 67 kips
Fb = 2.23(90 ) + 405 = 204 kips
Fc = 2.23(244 ) + 405 = 140 kips
Fd = 2.23(64 ) = 143 kips
The maximum collector force as shown in Figure 1A-17 is T = 204 kips .
The collector forces for east-west seismic loads exceed the chord forces calculated
for north-south seismic, and therefore govern the collector design at Line 1.
Use maximum T1 = 204 kips and minimum T1 = 140 kips .
The collector element can be implemented using either the wide flange spandrel
beams and connections or by adding supplemental slab reinforcing. In this
example, supplemental slab reinforcing is used. Under 1633.2.6, using the
strength design method, collectors must be designed for the special seismic load
combinations of 1612.4.
E m = Tm = oT = (2.2)T
46
1633.2.6
Design Example 1A
1612.4
(30-2)
(12-18)
1923.3.3
14.9 kips/ft
= 1.59 studs/ft
9.4 kips/stud
47
Design Example 1A
5.
2212
In this part, the design of a typical bay of bracing is demonstrated. The design bay,
taken from Elevation A, Figure 1A-4, is shown in Figure 1A-18. Member axial
forces and moments are given for dead, live, and seismic loads as output from the
computer model. All steel framing will be designed per Chapter 22, Division V,
Allowable Stress Design. Requirements for special concentrically braced frames
are given in 2213.9 of Chapter 22.
Design Example 1A
Pseis = 72 kips
PE = (Pseis ) = 1.0(72 ) = 72 kips
5a.
rd
1612.3.1
The basic ASD load combinations of 1612.3.1 with no one-third increase are
used.
D+
348
E
: 1 = 24 +
= 273 k (compression)
1.4
1.4
0.9 D
348
E
: 2 = 0.9(24 )
= 227 kips (tension)
1.4
1.4
348
E
D + 0.75 L +
= 219 kips (compression)
: 3 = 24 + 0.7511 +
1.4
1.4
(12-9)
(12-10)
(12-11)
The compressive axial load of Equation (12-9) controls. The clear unbraced length
(l ) of the TS brace is 18.5 feet, measured from the face of the beam or column.
Assuming k = 1.0 for pinned end,
kl = 1.0(18.5) = 18.5 ft
Maximum slenderness ratio:
2213.9.2.1
kl 1,000
r
Fy
49
Design Example 1A
Minimum r =
1,000
46
= 147.4
12(18.5)
kl
=
= 1.51in.
147.4
147.4
2213.9.2.4
b 110
= 16.2
Maximum width-thickness ratio
Fy
t
Try TS 8 8 5 8 :
r = 2.96 > 1.51 in.
o.k
b
8
=
= 12.8 < 16.2
t 0.625
o.k.
o.k.
Use TS8 8 5 8
5b.
rd
The girder will be designed using the basic load combinations of 1612.3.1 as
noted above. The loads are:
D + L : M D +L = 1,600 + 1,193 = 2,793 kip-in.
D
E
:
1.4
Pseis =
(12-8)
72
= 51.4 kips
1.4
(12-9)
M DL = 1,600 kip-in.
E
72
D + 0.75 L +
: Pseis = 0.75
= 38.6 kips
1.4
1.4
(12-11)
50
Design Example 1A
For the girder, use ASTM A36 steel with F y = 36 ksi . Assume that the bottom
beam flange is braced at third points
ly =
30
= 10.0 ft
3
As a starting point for design, assume a beam with a cross-section area of area of
20 in.2 Find the required beam section modulus.
fa =
51.4
= 2.6 ksi , and maximum Fa = 0.6(36 ) = 21.6 ksi then,
20
fa
2.6
=
= 0.12
Fa 21.6
For an allowable bending stress, use:
f b = (1 0.12 )(0.60)(36 ) = 19.0 ksi
S req'd
2,793
= 147 in.3
19.0
Try W 24 68 beam
S = 154 in.3
A = 20.1 in.2
rx = 9.55 in.
ry = 1.87 in.
12(30 )
kl
= 37.7
=
9.55
r x
12 (10.0 )
kl
= 64.2
=
1.87
r y
Fa = 17.02 ksi (compression governs)
51
Design Example 1A
Maximum f a =
51.4
= 2.55 ksi
20.1
fa
2.55
=
= 0.149 < 0.15
Fa 17.02
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
Use W 24 68 girder
Note that 2213.9.1 requires the girders to be continuous through brace
connections between adjacent columns. For chevron bracing configurations,
several additional requirements are placed on the girder design. Those
requirements are addressed in Design Example 1C. The X-bracing configuration
shown in this Example ensures the desired post-buckling capacity of the braced
frame without inducing the large unbalanced seismic loading on the girder that
occurs in a chevron brace configuration.
5c.
rd
The frame columns will also be designed using the basic load combinations of
1612.3.1 with no one-third increase.
D + L : P0 = 67 + 30 = 97 kips (compression)
D+
52
E
114
= 148.4 kips (compression)
: P1 = 67 +
1.4
1.4
(12-8)
(12-9)
Design Example 1A
0.9 D
E
114
: P2 = 0.9(67 )
= 21.1 kips (tension)
1.4
1.4
(12-10)
114
E
D + 0.75 L +
= 150.6 kips (compression)
: P3 = 67 + 0.75 30 +
1.4
1.4
(12-11)
Per the requirements of 2213.9.5, the columns must have the strength to resist the
special column strength requirements of 2213.5.1:
DL + 0.7 LL + o E :
Pcomp = 67 + 0.7(30 ) + 2.2(114 ) = 339 kips (compression)
2213.9.5, Item 1
0.85DL o E :
tens. = 0.85(67 ) 2.2(114 ) = 194 kips (tension)
2213.5.1, Item 2
For the columns, ASTM A36 steel with F y = 36 ksi will be used.
The unbraced column height (floor height less beam depth) is:
h = 15 1 = 14 ft
Try a W 10 49 column with kl = 14 ft
o.k.
Check the column for the special column strength requirements of 2213.5 using
member strength per 2213.4.2:
Psc = 1.7 Pallow
Psc = 1.7(242 ) = 411 > 339 kips (compression)
Pst = F y A = 36(14.4) = 518.4 > 194 kips (tension)
o.k.
o.k.
2213.4.2
Note that 2213.5.2 places special requirements on column splices. To ensure the
column splice can meet the ductility demand from the maximum earthquake force
(E m ) , full-penetration welds at splices are recommended. The splice must occur
within the middle one-third of the column clear height, not less than 4 feet above
the beam flange.
Finally, 2213.9.5 requires that the columns meet the width-thickness ratio limits
of 2213.7.3:
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
53
Design Example 1A
bf
2t f
For a W 10 49
bf
2t f
2213.7.3
10
(0.56) = 8.9 > 8.5
2
no good
Try a W 10 54
bf
2t f
o.k.
Thus, the column design is governed by the local buckling compactness criterion.
Use W10 x 54
6.
In this part, the connection of the TS8 8 brace to the W 10 column and W 24
girder will be designed. Connection of the braces to the mid-span of the girder is
similar, and is shown in Example 1C.
6a.
2213.9.2
Section 2213.9.3.1 requires that bracing connections have the strength to resist the
lesser of:
3. The strength of the brace in axial tension, Pst .
4. o times the design seismic forces, plus gravity loads.
5. The maximum force that can be transferred to the brace by the system.
For the TS8 8 5 8 brace used in the design bay, the connection force is taken as
the lesser of:
Pst = Fy A = 46(17.4 ) = 800.4 kips
54
controls
Design Example 1A
or:
Pm = PD + PL + o PE = (24 + 11) + 2.2 (348) = 800.6 kips
Use 800.4 kips for design
6b.
Based on research by AISC [Thornton, 1991], the Uniform Force Method (UFM)
has been presented as an efficient, reliable procedure for design of bracing
connections. The basis for the UFM is to configure the gusset dimensions so that
there are no moments at the connection interfaces: gusset-to-beam; gusset-tocolumn; and beam-to-column. [For more information on the UFM, refer to AISC
1994 LRFD, Volume II, Connections.]
Figure 1A-19 illustrates the gusset configuration and connection interface forces
for the UFM. Note that the distances to the centroids of the gusset connection,
and , are coincident with the brace centerline. To achieve the condition of no
moments at the interfaces, the following relationship must be satisfied:
tan = eb tan ec
The connection forces are then given by these equations:
r=
( + ec )2 + ( + eb )2
H b =
r
e
Vb = b
r
Vc =
r
e
H c = c
r
If the connection centroids do not occur at and , moments are induced on the
connection interface. The UFM can also be applied to this condition (see the LRFD
Connections manual for the Special Case No. 2 example). In some cases, it may be
beneficial to first select proportions for the gusset, then design the welds using
unbalanced moments computed per the UFM Special Case No. 2.
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
55
Design Example 1A
6c.
10.0
= 5.0" (W 10 54)
2
eb =
23.7
= 11.9" (W 24 68)
2
tan = eb tan ec
(1.0) = 11.9(1.0 ) 5.0
= 6.9 +
After a few trials, the following are selected: = 15.9" and = 9.0"
Using the axial strength of the brace, Pst = 800.4 kips , the connection interface
forces are as follows:
r=
= 29.56"
Gusset-to-beam:
15.9
11.9
H b = 800.4
= 431 kips , Vb = 800.4
= 322 kips
29.56
29.56
56
Design Example 1A
Gusset-to-column:
9.0
5.0
Vc = 800.4
= 244 kips , H c = 800.4
= 135 kips
29.56
29.56
From review of the computer output for the braced frame at the third floor, the
collector force (Ab ) to the beam connection is:
Ab = 41 kips
6d.
Brace-to-gusset design.
Bracing connections must have the strength to develop brace member forces per
2213.9.3.1. The capacities of the connection plates, welds and bolts are
determined under 2213.4.2.
Determine TS brace weld-to-gusset.
For 5/8-in. tube, minimum fillet weld is -in. Try -in. fillet weld using E70
electrodes.
Per inch, weld capacity = 1.7(8)(0.928) = 12.62 kips-in.
lreq =
800.4
= 15.9" @ 4 locations
12.62 ( 2)(2)
57
Design Example 1A
2213.9.3.3
Section 2213.9.3.3 requires the gusset plate to have flexural strength exceeding
that of the brace, unless the out-of-plane buckling strength is less than the in-plane
buckling strength and a setback of 2t is provided as shown in Figure 1A-19. The
gusset plate must also be designed to provide the required compressive capacity
without buckling. The 2t setback is a minimum requirement. A setback of 3t
provides for construction tolerance for brace fit-up, and should be considered
during design.
From Figure 1A-19, the gusset plate provides much greater in-plane fixity for the
tube. The effective length factor (k ) for out-of-plane buckling is by observation
greater than the in-plane factor (k ) , so the out-of-plane buckling strength will be
less than the in-plane buckling strength. The setback of 2t promotes enhanced
post-buckling behavior of the brace by allowing for hinging in the gusset instead of
the brace.
The gusset plate must be designed to carry the compressive strength of the brace
without buckling. Using the Whitmores Method (see AISC LRFD Manual Vol.
II), the effective plate width at Line A-A of Figure 1A-19a is:
b = tube width + 2 ( w ) tan 30 = 8 + 2 (18) tan 30 = 28.8 in.
The unsupported plate length Lu is taken as the centerline length from the end of
the brace to the edge of beam or column. From Figure 1-19a, this length measures
20 in. As recommended by Astaneh-Asl [1998], a value of k = 1.2 will be used.
Maximum l u = 20 in.
r=
t
1.0
=
= 0.289 in.
12 3.464
kl 1.2 (20 )
=
= 83.0 for F y = 36 ksi,
r
0.289
Fa = 15.0 ksi
Gusset capacity:
Pplate = 1.7(1.0)(28.8)(15.0 ) = 734 kips
58
2213.4.2
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
Design Example 1A
o.k.
Comment: Where tube sections are slotted for gusset plates, as shown in
Figure 1A-19, recent testing has shown that over-cut slots are of concern. Net
section fracture at the end of the slot should be checked considering shear lag at
the connection. If required, it is recommended that the tube section be reinforced
with a cover plate at the end of the slot.
Figure 1A-19. Connection design using the uniform force method (UFM)
59
Design Example 1A
6e.
Gusset-to-beam design.
In this section, the connection of the 1-inch-thick plate gusset to the W24 beam
will be designed. The weld length from gusset to beam is the plate length less the
1-inch clear distance between the beam and column.
l w = 2(15.9 1.0 clr ) = 29.8"
Per inch of effective throat area, weld stresses are:
fx =
Hb
431
=
= 7.23 ksi (x-component)
2(l w ) 2(29.8)
fy =
Vb
322
=
= 5.40 ksi (y-component)
2(l w ) 2(29.8)
(7.23)2 + (5.40)
fr =
2213.4.2
9.0
= 0.36 in.
35.7(0.707 )
Under AISC specifications (Table J2.4), the minimum weld for a 1-inch gusset
plate is 5/16-in., but as noted in Part 6c, we increase the weld size by a factor of
1.4 for ductility.
t weld = 0.36(1.4 ) = 0.50 in. use -in. fillet weld
Comparing the double-sided fillet to the allowable plate shear stress, the minimum
plate thickness is:
t pl =
2 (0.707 )(21)(0.50 )
= 1.0 in.
0.4 (36.0 )
1-inch plate
60
o.k.
Design Example 1A
N = lw = 29.8 in.
R = Vb = 322 kips
R
1.33(0.66 )F y
t w (N + 2.5 k )
322 kips
= 23.3 ksi 1.33 (0.66 )(36 ksi ) = 31.6 ksi
(0.415)(29.8 + 2.5 (1.375))
6f.
AISC-ASD, K1.3
o.k.
Gusset-to-column design.
The gusset plate connection to the column is designed using the same procedure as
the gusset-beam connection.
The weld length to the column is:
lw = 2(9 ) = 18 in.
Per inch of effective throat area, weld stresses are:
fx =
Hc
135
=
= 3.75 ksi (x-component)
2(l w ) 2(18)
fy =
Vc
244
=
= 6.77 ksi (y-component)
2(l w ) 2(18)
fr =
(3.75)2 + (6.77 )2
Determine the required weld size, with the 1.4 factor to enhance ductility of the
weld.
7.75 ksi
t weld = 1.4
= 0.42 in.
35.7(0.707 )
o.k.
61
Design Example 1A
6g.
AISC-ASD K1.3
o.k.
Beam-to-column connection.
The connection of the W 24 beam to the W 10 column must carry the dead and live
loads on the beam as well as the vertical and horizontal components of the brace
force transferred from the gusset plates to the top and bottom of the beam.
From the diagonal brace above the beam (see Figure 1A-19d), the connection
forces to the beam are:
Ab + H c = 41 + 135 = 176 kips
Rb = V DL + V LL = 14.1 + 10.3 = 24.4 kips
Rb + Vb = 24.4 + 322 = 346 kips
The diagonal brace below the beam also contributes to the beam-to-column
connection forces. The horizontal component from the brace below (H c ) acts
opposite to the brace above, while the vertical component (Vb ) adds to that from
the brace above. The connection forces above are based on the tensile capacity of
the brace, so it is reasonable to use the compressive strength of the brace below.
Assuming a TS8 8 5 8 -in. brace below:
Psc = 1.7(324 ) = 551 kips
Vb = 322(551 800 ) = 222 kips
H c = 135(551 800) = 93 kips
The net beam-to-column connection forces (as shown in Figure 1A-19b) are:
Ab + H c = 176 93 = 83 kips
Rb + Vb = 346 + 222 = 568 kips
62
Design Example 1A
83
= 3.95 ksi (x-component)
(21)(1)
fy =
568
= 27.0 ksi (y-component)
(21)(1)
Z plastic =
(21)2
4
= 110.3
f xx =
1,704
= 15.4 ksi (rotation)
110.3
fr =
f r (1) 33.2
=
= 0.66 in.
Fy
50
2213.4.2
no good
o.k.
63
Design Example 1A
2213.9.3.2
2213.8.3.2
Ae 1.2F *
Ag
Fu
(13-6)
where:
F* =
83
= 3.95 ksi
(1.0)(21)
o.k.
83
= 5.9 kips
14
Fy =
568
= 40.6 kips
14
FR =
(5.9)2 + (40.6)2
= 41.0 kips
For 1-1/4-in. diameter A490-SC bolts, the allowable shear bolt is:
Vbolt = 1.7(25.8) = 43.9 kips > 41.0 kips
o.k.
64
Design Example 1A
Commentary
As shown on the frame elevations (Figure 1A-4), a horizontal steel strut has been
provided between the columns at the foundation. Welded shear studs are installed
on this strut with the capacity to transfer the horizontal seismic force resisted by
the frame onto the foundations, through grade beams or the slab-on-grade. This
technique provides redundancy in the transfer of seismic shear to the base, and is
recommended as an alternate to transferring the frame shear force solely through
the anchor bolts.
References
AISC-ASD, 1989. Manual of Steel Construction, Allowable Stress Design.
American Institute of Steel Construction, Chicago, Illinois. 9th Edition.
AISC/LRFD, 1994. Manual of Steel Construction, Load and Resistance Factor
Design. Volumes I and II. American Institute of Steel Construction, Chicago,
Illinois. 2nd Edition.
Astaneh-Asl, A., 1998. Seismic Behavior and Design of Gusset Plates, SteelTips. Structural Steel Educational Council.
Cochran, Michael, 2000. Design and Detailing of Steel SCBF Connections,
SEAONC Seminar Series. Structural Engineers Association of California,
Sacramento, California.
Hassan, O. and Goel, S., 1991. Seismic Behavior and Design of Concentrically
Braced Steel Structures. Dept. of Civil Engineering, University of Michigan.
ICBO, 1998. Maps of Known Active Fault Near-Source Zones in California and
Adjacent Portions of Nevada. International Conference of Building Officials,
Whittier, California.
Lee, S. and Goel, S., 1987. Seismic Behavior of Hollow and Concrete Filled
Square Tubular Bracing Members. Dept. of Civil Engineering, University of
Michigan.
Sabelli, R., and Hohbach, D., 1999. Design of Cross-Braced Frames for
Predictable Buckling Behavior, Journal of Structural Engineering. American
Society of Civil Engineers, Vol.125, no.2, February 1999.
Thornton, W., 1991. On the Analysis and Design of Bracing Connections,
National Steel Conference Proceedings. American Institute of Steel Construction,
pp. 26.1-26.33 Chicago, Illinois.
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
65
Design Example 1A
66
Design Example 1B
Design Example 1B
Ordinary Concentric Braced Frame
Figure 1B-1. Four-story steel frame office building with ordinary concentric braced frames (OCBF)
Overview
This Design Example illustrates the differences in design requirements for an
ordinary concentric braced frame (OCBF) and a special concentric braced frame
(SCBF) (illustrated in Design Example 1A). The same four-story steel frame
structure from Example 1A is used in this Design Example (Figure 1B-1).
Building weights, dimensions, and site seismicity are the same as Example 1A.
Coefficients for seismic base shear are revised as required for the OCBF. The
typical design bay is revised for the OCBF, and the results compared to those for
the SCBF structure.
It is recommended that the reader first review Design Example 1A before reading
this Design Example. Refer to Example 1A for plans and elevations of the
structure (Figures 1A-1 through 1A-4).
67
Design Example 1B
In the Blue Book Commentary (C704.12), OCBFs are not recommended for
areas of high seismicity or for essential facilities and special occupancy
structures. SCBFs are preferred for those types of structures, since SCBFs
are expected to perform better in a large earthquake due to their ductile
design and detailing. OCBFs are considered more appropriate for use in
one-story light-framed construction, non-building structures and in areas
of low seismicity.
Outline
This Design Example illustrates the following parts of the design process:
1.
2.
3.
Interstory drifts.
4.
5.
1.
1a.
Code Reference
1629.6
68
Table 16-N
Design Example 1B
1b.
1629.8.3
The static lateral force procedure will be used, as permitted for irregular structures
not more than five stories or 65 feet in height.
1c.
1629.4.3
1d.
Table 16-Q
Table 16-R
1e.
V =
Cv I
0.69(1.0)
W =
W = 0.216W
RT
5.6(0.57)
1630.2.2
1630.2.1
(30-4)
V =
2 .5C a I
2 . 5 ( 0 . 44 ) (1 . 0 )
W =
= 0 . 196 W
R
5 .6
(30-5)
0.8ZN v I
0.8(0.4)(1.08)(1.0)
W =
= 0.062W
R
5.6
(30-7)
69
Design Example 1B
1f.
1630.1
20
Reliability/redundancy factor = 2
(30-3)
rmax Ab
2.
2a.
E = E h + E v = 1.0(V )
(30-1)
E m = E h = 2.2(V )
(30-2)
The weight and mass distribution for the building is shown in Table 1B-1. These
values are taken from Design Example 1A.
Table 1B-1. Mass properties summary
2b.
Level
W
(kips)
Roof
4th
3rd
2nd
6,687
6,840
6,840
6,840
Total
27,207
X cg
Ycg
(ft)
161.1
161.1
161.1
161.1
MMI
(ft)
M
(kip sec2/in.)
1,80.9
1,80.9
1,80.9
1,80.9
17.3
17.7
17.7
17.7
316,931
324,183
324,183
324,183
70.4
70
(30-5)
Design Example 1B
2c.
1630.5
For the Static lateral force procedure, vertical distribution of force to each level is
applied as follows:
Fx =
W h
(V Ft )W x h x
= V x x
Wi hi
Wi hi
(30-15)
3.
3a.
Level
wx
(kips)
hx
(ft)
w x hx
(ft)
w x hx
w x hx
Fx
(kips)
V
(kips)
Roof
4th
3rd
2nd
6,687
6,840
6,840
6,840
62
47
32
17
414,594
321,480
218,880
116,280
0.39
0.30
0.20
0.11
2,064
1,600
1,090
579
2,064
3,665
4,754
Total
27,207
1,071,234
1.00
5,333
5,333
Determine M.
3b.
(30-17)
The maximum interstory drift (obtained from a computer analysis and summarized
in Table 1A-7 of Design Example 1A) occurs in the north-south direction at the
second story, and is 0.36 inches with R = 5.6 . This value must be adjusted for the
R = 6.2 used for OCBF systems.
6.2
S drift =
(0.36") = 0.40 in.
5.6
M drift = 0.40(3.92 ) = 1.57 in.
Drift ratio =
1.57
= 0.009 < 0.025
180
o.k.
1630.10.2
71
Design Example 1B
Comment: The elastic story displacement is greater for the SCBF than the OCBF,
but the maximum inelastic displacement ( M ) is equivalent to the SCBF. Drift
limitations rarely, if ever, govern braced frame designs. And, as a design
consideration, there is essentially no difference in the calculated maximum drifts
for OCBFs and SCBFs.
4.
Braced frame member design will be done using the same typical design bay as
shown in Example 1A. SCBF member seismic forces are increased proportionally
for the OCBF using a ratio of the R values. Member axial forces and moments for
dead load and seismic loads are shown below (Figure 1B-2). All steel framing is
designed per Chapter 22, Division V, Allowable Stress Design. Requirements for
braced frames, except SCBF and EBF, are given in 2213.8.
DL = 24 kips
LL = 11 kips
E = 400 kips
72
Design Example 1B
4a.
rd
The basic ASD load combinations of 1612.3.1 with no one-third increase will be
used.
D+
400
E
: P1 = 24 +
= 310 kips (compression)
1.4
1.4
0.9 D
400
E
: P2 = 0.9(24 )
= 264 kips (tension)
1.4
1.4
400
E
D + 0.75 L +
= 246 kips (compression)
: P3 = 24 + 0.7511 +
1.4
1.4
(12-9)
(12-10)
(12-11)
73
Design Example 1B
r
Fy
2213.8.2.1
720
= 106
46
Minimum r =
12(18.5)
kl
=
= 2.09 in.
106
106
b 110
= 16.2
Maximum width-thickness ratio
Fy
t
2213.8.2.5
Try TS 10 10 5 8 .
r = 3.78 > 2.09"
o.k.
b
10
=
= 16.0 < 16.2
t 0.625
o.k.
(13-4)
(13-5)
where:
Cc =
2 2 E
Fy
( Kl ) / r =
B=
74
AISC-ASD E2
1.0(12)(18.5)
= 58.7
3.78
1
= 0.79
1 + [58.7 2 (111.6 )]
Design Example 1B
For kl = 18.5 ft
Pallow = 482 kips
o.k.
Use TS 10 10 5 8
4b.
rd
From a review of Design Example 1A, the vertical load moment governs the girder
design. With only a nominal increase in axial force from seismic loading, the
girder is okay by inspection.
4c.
rd
The columns will be designed using the basic ASD load combinations with no onethird increase.
D + L : 1 = 67 + 30 = 97 kips (compression)
D+
(12-8)
130
E
: 1 = 67 +
= 160 kips (compression)
1.4
1.4
0.9 D
(12-9)
130
E
: 2 = 0.9(67 )
= 33 kips (tension)
1.4
1.4
(12-10)
130
E
D + 0.75 L +
= 159 kips (compression)
: 3 = 67 + 0.7530 +
1.4
1.4
(12-11)
For the columns, ASTM A36 steel with F y = 36 ksi . The unbraced column height is:
h = 15 1 = 14 ft
Per AISC-ASD manual, p. 3-30, select a W 10 49 column with kl = 14 ft .
Pallow = 242 > 160 kips
o.k.
Use W 10 49 column
75
Design Example 1B
Note that without the local buckling compactness requirement of 2213.9.2.4, the
W 10 49 works in the OCBF, where a W 10 54 is required for the SCBF of
Example 1A. Also note that the special column strength requirements of 2213.5.1
do not apply to the OCBF. The relaxation of ductility requirements for the OCBF
reflects lesser inelastic displacement capacity than the SCBF, hence the greater
seismic design forces for the OCBF.
5.
2213.8.3
The design provisions for OCBF connections are nearly identical to those for
SCBF connections, with one significant difference. The SCBF requirements for
gusset plates do not apply to OCBF connections. Therefore, the minimum 2t
setback, as shown in Figure 1A-19(a) of Design Example 1A for the SCBF, may be
eliminated. This allows the end of the tube brace to extend closer to the beamcolumn intersection, thereby reducing the size of the gusset plate.
Under the requirements of 2213.8.3.1, the OCBF connections must be designed
for the lesser of:
1.
2213.8.3.1
The remainder of the connection design follows the same procedure as for Design
Example 1A, with all components designed for the 915 kip force derived above.
76
Design Example 1C
Design Example 1C
Chevron Braced Frame
Figure 1C-1. Four-story steel frame office building with chevron braced frames
Overview
This Example illustrates the additional design requirements for chevron bracing
designed as either an Ordinary Concentric Braced Frame (OCBF) or a Special
Concentric Braced Frame (SCBF). The typical design bay from Design
Example 1A is modified for use in this example. For comparison, the member
forces are assumed to be the same as for Design Examples 1A and 1B. It is
recommended that the reader first review Design Examples 1A and 1B before
reading this example. Refer to Design Example 1A for plans and elevations of the
structure (Figures 1A-1 through 1A-4).
77
Design Example 1C
Outline
This Design Example illustrates the following parts of the design process:
1.
Bracing configuration.
2.
3.
4.
1.
Code Reference
Bracing configuration.
2213.2, 2213.8
Section 2213.2 defines chevron bracing as that form of bracing where a pair of
braces located either above or below a beam terminates at a single point within the
clear beam span. It also defines V-bracing and inverted V-bracing as chevron
bracing occurring above or below the beam (Figure 1C-2).
Chevron V-bracing
Design Example 1C
2.
For comparison, assume the forces to the diagonal bracing members are the same
as for Example 1B:
TS brace @ 3rd story:
PDL = 24 kips
PLL = 11 kips
PE = 400 kips
79
Design Example 1C
For OCBF chevron bracing, 2213.8.4.1 requires that the seismic force be
increased by a factor of 1.5:
PE = 1.5(400 ) = 600 kips
2213.8.4
Also note that the same section requires the beam to be continuous between
columns, and that the beam be capable of supporting gravity loads without support
from the diagonal braces. From Design Example 1A, the W 24 68 girder satisfies
these conditions.
For the diagonal brace at the third story, we have the following basic ASD load
combinations with no one-third increase:
D+
600
E
: P1 = 24 +
= 453 kips (compression)
1.4
1.4
0.9 D
600
E
: P2 = 0.9(24 )
= 407 kips (tension)
1.4
1.4
600
E
D + 0.75 L +
= 354 kips (compression)
: P3 = 24 + 0.75 11 +
1.4
1.4
(12-9)
(12-10)
(12-11)
n.g.
2213.8.2.5
For F y = 50 ksi;
80
720
50
2213.8.2.1
kl
720
r
Fy
= 102
Design Example 1C
Minimum r =
12(18.5)
kl
=
= 2.18 in.
102
102
bf
Maximum width-thickness ratio
2t
65
= 9.2
Fy
o.k.
o.k.
2213.8.2.2
Pas = BPa
(13-4)
B = 1 /{1 + [(kl / r ) / 2C c ]}
(13-5)
kl / ry =
B=
1.0(12)(18.5)
= 70.9
3.13
1
= 0.75
1 + [70.9 / 2(107)]
For kl = 18.5
Pa = 733 kips
Pas = (0.75)(733) = 550 > 453 kips
3.
2213.9.4.1
For SCBF chevron bracing, 2213.9.4.1 does not require the seismic force to be
increased by a factor of 1.5 as is required for OCBF chevron braces. This provision
is waived for SCBF chevron bracing due to an additional requirement for beam
design. As for OCBF braces, 2213.9.4.1 also requires the beam to be continuous
between columns, and that the beam be capable of supporting gravity loads
without support from the diagonal braces. Additionally, for special chevron
bracing, the beam intersected by chevron braces is to have sufficient strength to
resist gravity loads combined with unbalanced brace forces. This requirement
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
81
Design Example 1C
provides for overall frame stability, and enhanced post-buckling behavior, with
reduced contribution from the buckled compression bracing members.
For comparison, assume the member forces remain the same as for Design
Example 1A.
TS brace @ 3rd story:
PDL = 24 kips
PLL = 11 kips
PE = 348 kips
WF beam @ 3rd story:
M DL = 1,600 kip-in.
M LL = 1,193 kip-in.
V DL = 14.1 kips
V LL = 72 kips
PE = 72 kips
3a.
The diagonal brace design for the SCBF chevron brace remains the same as that of
the two-story X-brace presented in Design Example 1A.
3b.
rd
( )
Design Example 1C
The maximum unbalanced brace force Pb is taken as the net difference of the
vertical components of Pst and 0.3Psc as show in Figure 1C-4.
P st
2213.9.4.1
0.3P sc
2213.9.4.1, Item 3
( )
M s = Z F y > M max
Z reqd 42927 50 = 859 in.3
Try W 36 232
Z = 936 in.3 > 859 in.3
o.k.
83
Design Example 1C
4.
2213.9.3.1
The brace to beam connection is shown in Figure 1C-5 below. This Example uses
the SCBF bracing and forces. The design for the OCBF connection is similar,
without the 2t setback between the end of the brace and the line of restraint for the
gusset plate, as required for SCBF systems.
84
Design Example 1C
4a.
From Design Example 1A, the TS 8 8 5 8 brace strength is used for connection
design. The brace-to-gusset design is as given in Part 6d of Design Example 1A:
Connection force:
( )
2"
fv =
2(800.4)
2
= 1,132 kips
1,132 kips
= 13.1 ksi
1.0(86 in.)
o.k.
2213.4.2
Z=
2(18)(800.4 )
2
= 20,375 kip-in.
1.0(86 )2
= 1,849 in.4
4
fb =
20,375
= 11.0 ksi
1,849
85
Design Example 1C
Fa = 19.08 ksi
Allowable Fsc = 1.7(Fa ) = 1.7(19.08) = 32.4 ksi > 11.0 ksi
o.k.
4b.
Length of weld to beam is l w = 86 inches. Minimum fillet weld for 1-inch plate is
5/16-inch. Per inch of effective throat area, weld stresses are:
fx =
V
1,132
=
= 6.58 ksi (x-axis)
2(l w ) 2(86)
fy =
20,375(6 )
M
=
= 8.26 ksi (y-axis)
Sw
2(86 )2
fr =
(6.58)2 + (8.26)2
2213.4.2
10.56
= 0.41in.
0.707(35.7 )
86
Design Example 1C
Commentary
The Blue Book Commentary warns that even with the strong-beam SCBF chevron,
configurations may be susceptible to large inelastic displacements and P-delta
effects. To mitigate these effects, chevron configurations that use two-story
X-bracing or zipper columns are recommended. These bracing configurations are
presented in the section Factors That Influence Design at the beginning of Design
Example 1A.
87
Design Example 1C
88
Design Example 2
Design Example 2
Eccentric Braced Frame
Overview
Use of eccentric braced frames (EBFs) in steel frame buildings in high seismic
regions is a fairly recent development. This system was introduced in the 1988
UBC. While the concept has been thoroughly tested in laboratories, it has not yet
been extensively tested in actual earthquakes. Many structural engineers, however,
feel that it offers superior earthquake resistance. Following the problems with steel
moment frame connections in the 1994 Northridge earthquake, many buildings that
previously would have been designed as SMRF structures are now being designed
with EBF systems.
Eccentric braced frames may be configured with several geometric patterns,
including centrally located links (as chosen in this problem) or with links located
adjacent to columns. When links are located adjacent to columns, a seismic SMRF
connection is required at the link beam/column intersection. Several papers and
many practitioners recommend that configurations using centrally located links be
chosen to avoid the use of link beam/column SMRF connections, which increase
the risk of brittle failure. Braces may be oriented to slope up to central link beams
(inverted V braces) or down (V braces) to central link beams. Also, a twostory frame section can be designed with upper and lower braces meeting at a
common link beam located between the two levels.
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
89
Design Example 2
It is also desirable to prevent single-story yield mechanisms. Some options for this
include using inverted braces at two levels with common link beams, which
ensures two story yield mechanisms, or zipper columns at either side of link beams,
extending from the second level to the roof, which ensures multi-story
mechanisms.
In this Design Example, the five-story steel frame building shown schematically in
Figure 2-1 is to have eccentric braced frames for its lateral force resisting system.
The floor and roof diaphragms consist of lightweight concrete fill over steel
decking. A typical floor/roof plan for the building is shown in Figure 2-2. A typical
EBF frame elevation is shown in Figure 2-3.
The typical frame is designed in both allowable stress design (ASD) and load and
resistance factor design (LRFD) because the code allows a designer the choice of
either design method. The LRFD method is from the 1997 AISC-Seismic, which is
considered by SEAOC to be the most current EBF design method. The ASD
method has been in the UBC for several cycles and is considered to be older, not
updated, code methodology.
Outline
This Design Example illustrates the following parts of the design process.
1.
2.
Reliability/redundancy factor.
3.
4.
5.
6.
EBF member design using load and resistance factor design (LRFD).
7.
90
Design Example 2
Given Information
Roof weights:
Roofing
Insulation
Steel deck and fill
Roof framing
Partition walls (10 psf)
Ceiling
Mechanical/electrical
Total
6.0 psf
3.0
47.0
8.0
5.0 seismic
3.0
2.0
74.0 psf
Floor weights:
Floor covering
Steel deck and fill
Framing (beams and columns)
Partition walls
Ceiling
Mechanical/electrical
Total
1.0 psf
47.0
13.0
10.0
3.0
2.0
76.0 psf
Live load:
50.0 psf
Live load:
20.0 psf
20.0 psf
Structural materials:
Wide flange shapes and plates
Weld electrodes
Light weight concrete fill
E70XX
f c ' = 3,000 psi
Table 16-I
Table 16-K
91
Design Example 2
92
Design Example 2
1.
Code Reference
The static force procedure will be used and the building period is calculated using
Method A.
T = Ct (hn )3 4 = .030(62 )3 4 = .66 sec
1630.2
1630.2.2
(30-8)
Near source factors for seismic source type A and distance to source of 5 km are:
N a = 1.2
Table 16-S
N v = 1.6
Table 16-T
Table 16-Q
Table 16-R
Cv I
1.02(1.0 )
W =
W = 0.22W
RT
7(0.66 )
Table 16-N
1630.2.1
(30-4)
2.5C a I
2.5(.53)(1.0 )
W =
W = 0.189W
R
7
(30-5)
(30-6)
93
Design Example 2
In addition, for Seismic Zone 4, the total base shear shall also not be less than:
V =
0.8ZN v I
0.8(0.4)(1.6)(1.0)
W =
W = 0.073W
R
7
(30-7)
2.
Reliability/redundancy factor.
1630.1.1
The reliability/redundancy factor must be estimated. The factor was added to the
code to penalize non-redundant systems. It varies from a minimum of 1.0 to a
maximum of 1.5. It is determined for each principal direction. Since the building in
this Design Example has four frames in the east-west direction, is determined
based on eight braces (two per frame) and a maximum torsional contribution of 2
percent (thus 1.02). The assumption is that all frames will be identical and that the
horizontal component carried by each brace is equal. This assumption can be
checked after final analysis. However, in this analysis it is determined without a
structural analysis.
= 2
20
(30-3)
rmax AB
AB = 212 15 = 32,224 ft 2
rmax =
1
= 0.128 (8 braces, 2 percent from torsion)
8(1.02)
1.0 1.5
= 2
20
.128 32,224
1630.1.1
= 1.13
(30-3)
94
Design Example 2
3.
1630.5
The floor area at each level is 32,224 square feet. The perimeter of the exterior
curtain wall is 728 feet. The roof parapet height is 4 feet. Assume that the curtain
wall weights distribute to each floor by tributary height.
The building mass calculation is shown in Table 2-1.
3a.
Level
Floor area
(sf)
wi
(psf)
Wr f
(kips)
Length
exterior
walls
(ft)
h Walls
(ft)
Roof
5
4
3
2
32,224
32,224
32,224
32,224
32,224
74
76
76
76
76
2,385
2,449
2,449
2,449
2,449
728
728
728
728
728
10
12
12
12
13
Totals
161,120
w i Walls W Walls
(kips)
(psf)
20
20
20
20
20
12,181
Wi
(kips)
146
175
175
175
11
2,530
2,624
2,624
2,624
2,660
871
13,062
1630.2.1
Using the design base shear coefficient from Part 1, the base shear for the east-west
direction is
V = 1.13 0.189W = 1.13 0.189(12900 ) = 2,789 k
3b.
1630.5
The total lateral force (i.e., design base shear) is distributed over the height of the
building in accordance with 1630.5. The following equations apply:
n
V = Ft + Fi
(30-13)
Ft = 0.07TV 0.25V
(30-14)
i =1
(V Ft )w x hx
wx hx
(30-15)
95
Design Example 2
Using the building mass tabulated in Table 2-1 above, the vertical distribution of
shear is determined as shown in Table 2-2 below.
4.
wx
(k)
w
(k)
2,530 2,530
2,624 5,154
2,624 7,778
2,624 10,401
2,660 13,062
13,062
hx
(ft)
h
(ft)
w x hx
(k-ft)
w x hx
w i h i
(%)
Fx
(k)
VI
(k)
62
50
38
26
14
12
12
12
12
14
156,871
131,187
99,702
68,217
37,242
493,220
32
27
20
14
7
100
887
742
564
386
211
2,789
887
1,629
2,193
2,598
,789
2
1630.6
Although the centers of mass and rigidity coincide, 1630.6 requires designing for
an additional torsional eccentricity, e , equal to 5 percent of the building dimension
perpendicular to the direction of force regardless of the relative location of the
centers of mass and rigidity.
eew = (0.05)(150 ) = 7.5 ft for east-west direction
ens = (0.05)(210) = 10.5 ft for north-south direction
Assume that all frames have the same rigidity, since all are similar EBFs. This
assumption can be refined in a subsequent analysis, after members have been sized
and an elastic deflection analysis has been completed. Many designers estimate the
torsional contribution for a symmetric building by adding 5 percent to 10 percent to
the element forces. However, in this Design Example the numerical application of
the code provisions will be shown.
Assume R1 = R2 = ...R14 = 1.0 , where Ri is the rigidity of each EBF frame.
The calculation of direct shear plus torsion for a given frame is based on the
following formula:
V ec
V
i
Vi = Ri i Ri
2
R
R xy c
96
Design Example 2
Table 2-3 gives the distribution of direct shear and torsional shear components as
percentages of shear force (based on geometry).
Table 2-3. Calculation of direct shear plus torsion as percentage of story shear
Frame
X(ft) (1) Y(ft) (1)
ID
Longitudinal
1
2
3
4
Transverse
5 -110
6 -110
7
10
8
10
9
100
10
100
75
75
75
75
X 2Ri
Ri XRi YRi
1
1
1
1
-75
-75
75
75
1 -110
1 -110
1
10
1
10
1 100
1 100
Y 2Ri
J=
Rd
5,625
5,625
5,625
5,625
Sum Vi Vy
Sum
Ty (%) (3) V
Vi / Vy (2) Tx (%) (3) V (%) (2)
i
I
(%)
25%
25%
25%
25%
12,100
12,100
100
100
10,000
10,000
-0.84%
-0.84%
0.84%
0.84%
25.00%
25.00%
25.84%
25.84%
-1.23%
-1.23%
0.11%
0.11%
1.12%
1.12%
Totals
-1.18%
-1.18%
1.18%
1.18%
16.7%
16.7%
16.7%
16.7%
16.7%
16.7%
-1.73%
-1.73%
0.16%
0.16%
1.57%
1.57%
16.7%
16.7%
16.9%
16.9%
18.3%
18.3%
0%
100%
0%
Notes:
1. X and Y are distances from the center of mass (i.e., the center of the building) to frames in
the X and Y directions, respectively.
2. Vx and Vy are direct shears on frames in the X and Y directions, respectively.
3. Tx and Ty are shear forces on frames that resist torsional moments on the building. These
shear forces are either in the X or Y directions and can be additive or subtractive with
direct shear forces.
4.
66,900(4) 100%
Rd 2 = x Ri + y 2 Ri
Based on the direct and torsional shear values tabulated in Table 2-3, and on the
vertical distribution of shear tabulated in Table 2-2, the story forces to be used for
design of the typical eccentric braced frame (EBF4) are as follows:
Level
Story V x
(kips)
Story Tx
(ft-kips)
Frame V4
(kips)
Frame T4
(kips)
(kips)
Story Fx ,4
(kips)
4
4
4
4
4
R
5
4
3
2
887
1,629
2,193
2,578
2,789
6,653
12,217
16,445
19,338
20,918
222
407
548
645
697
7
14
18
22
23
229
421
567
666
721
229
192
146
99
55
Vi ,6
97
Design Example 2
5.
In the 1997 UBC, a designer has a choice of whether to design using allowable
stress design (ASD) methods or whether to use load and resistance factor design
(LRFD) methods. In part 5, the ASD method is illustrated. In part 6, the LRFD
method is illustrated. The results are slightly different, depending on the method
chosen.
5a.
2213.10
Seismic forces on a typical EBF, in this case EBF4 on line 6, will be determined.
The forces E , applied to EBF4 are calculated first by determining the seismic load
along line 6. The unit shear load along line 6, vi 6 , is thus Vi 6 210 feet.
Frame EBF4 has a tributary collector length of 210 feet / 2 = 105 feet, and tributary
lengths on the west side of the frame of 60 feet and on the east side of the frame of
45 feet. The frame forces are thus F4iL = vi 6 (60 feet) and F4iR = vi 6 (45 feet). The
compression force in the link is equal to half the story shear tributary to the frame,
minus the frame force at the right side (F4iL + F4iR ) 2 F4iR . Table 2-5
summarizes the forces at each level of frame EBF4.
Frame
Fx ,4
R
5
4
3
2
5b.
(kips)
Line 6
Vi 4
(klf)
229
192
146
100
54
2.18
1.83
1.39
0.95
0.51
FxiL
(west)
(kips)
FxiR
(east)
(kips)
C =T
(link)
(kips)
131.0
109.5
83.2
57.0
31.1
98.2
82.1
62.4
42.7
23.3
16.4
13.7
10.4
7.1
3.9
Link length.
The inelastic behavior of a link is influenced by its length, e . The shorter the link
length, the greater the influence of shear forces on the inelastic performance. Shear
yielding tends to occur uniformly along the link length. Shear yielding of short
links is very ductile with an inelastic capacity in excess of that predicted by
calculations.
The following is a summary of link behavior as a function of the link length e .
MS is the flexural strength of the link and VS is the shear strength. Both are defined
in 2213.4.2.
98
Design Example 2
1.0
M
MS
e 1.3 S
VS
VS
e 1.6
MS
VS
e > 2.0
MS
VS
e 3.0
MS
VS
The shorter the link length, the stiffer the EBF frame will be; however, the greater
the link rotation. The code sets limits on link plastic rotation of 0.090 radians
(ASD) and 0.080 radians (LRFD) due to m deflections. For most designs, link
lengths of 1.0 to 1.3 M s Vs work well.
5c.
Preliminary sizes of the EBF frame beams are determined by calculating the
required shear area (dt w ) due to the story forces and frame geometry. The load
combinations for allowable stress design procedures are given in Equations (12-7)
through (12-11) or (12-12) through (12-16) in 1612.3. These load combinations
use load values of E 1.4 to account for allowable stress design.
V3 = 666kips/1.4/2
= 237.8 kips
V2 = 721k/1.4/2
= 257.4 kips
15'
15'
Level 3
Level 2
V2, link
V3, link
12'
14'
99
Design Example 2
For initial sizing, shear forces in the links may be approximated as follows:
Vi ,link =
Vi ( h) Vi / 2( h)
=
l
l/2
V2,link
721 kips
(14' )
= 240.2 kips
= 1.4
30'
V3,link
666 kips
(12' )
= 190.4 kips
= 1.4
30'
V4,link
567 kips
(12' )
= 161.9 kips
= 1.4
30'
V5,link
421 kips
(12' )
= 120.3 kips
= 1.4
30'
V R ,link
229 kips
(12' )
= 65.5 kips
= 1.4
30'
V i ,link
0.80 0.55 F y
2213.10.5
V s = .55 F y dt w
M s= Zx F y
Preliminary beam sizes are determined as shown in Table 2-6 (forces are E 1.4 ).
100
Design Example 2
Table 2-6. Preliminary link analysis and sizing for frame EBF4
Vi ,link
min.
Fi
Story Vi
req.
dtw
Level h
2
2
(ft) (kips) (kips) link (in.2)
shear
R
12
5
4
81.9 81.9
Link
Beam
Size
d
(in.)
1.3
tw
(in.)
dtw
(in.2)
Zx
Ms
Vs
M s Vs
(in.3) (k-in.) (kips)
(in.)
1.6
M s Vs
47.2
(in.)
Link
Lg.
(in.)
58.1
24
3.16
65.5
2.98
W16x77
16.52 0.46
7.52
150.0
7500 207
12
5.47
W18X86
18.39 0.48
8.83
186.0
9300 243
49.8
61.3
34
2.02
12
7.36
W18X97
18.59 0.54
9.95
50.1
61.7
36
1.69
12
8.65
W18X97
18.59 0.54
9.95
50.1
61.7
36
1.44
14
55.5
68.3
46
1.62
MS
VS
A computer model has been created for EBF4. The results of the computer
analysis, including forces and displacements, have been determined. The computer
model was analyzed with moment resisting connections, which more closely
estimates the real behavior of the frame with end moments much less than M p .
For the first story, the EBF member design will be based on use of a W 21 132
link beam at Level 2.
5d.
Link rotation.
The frame displacement at the second level, S 2 , was determined from a separate
computer analysis (not shown) using the design base shear (not divided by 1.4) and
not increased by because frame distortion limits are based on calculations using
applied strength level seismic forces not increased by the redundancy factor.
S 2 = 0.48 in.
101
Design Example 2
(30-17)
The link rotation is computed as a function of the frame story drift and frame
geometry. For a frame of story height h , bay width l , link length e , and
(l e) , the link rotation may be calculated by the following
dimensions a =
2
formula [Becker and Ishler, 1996]. Link rotations, , must be limited to 0.090
radians per 2213.10.4.
=
M
2 a 1.37"
2(157 ")
l +
=
l +
= 0.060 radians 0.090
e 180"
h
46"
o.k.
Note that the frame height, h , in the first story is 180 inches, or 15 ft-0 in. because
the base plate is anchored 12 inches below the slab.
5e.
2213.10.5
The purpose of EBF design is to ensure that any inelastic behavior in the structure
under seismic motions occurs in the links. To achieve this, all elements other than
the links are designed to have strengths greater than the forces that will be induced
in them when the links experience yielding. Therefore, if the links have excess
capacity, all other elements in the frame (braces, columns, link beams outside the
link lengths) will also have corresponding excess capacity. Section 2213.10.5
requires than the link shear does not exceed 0.8Vs under design seismic forces.
Thus links have a minimum overstrength factor min = (1.0 0.8) = 1.25 which
provides a safety factor on shear capacity. Depending on the actual link beam
chosen for design, the link overstrength factor, , may be greater than 1.25. Thus,
for the W 21 132 link beam with applied shear Vi ,link = 240.2 kips (see
Table 2-6):
V s = .55 F y dt w = .55 (50 ksi )(21.83")(.650") = 390.2 kips
=
390.2 k
Vs
=
= 1.62 1.25
V i,link 240.2 k
o.k .
2213.4.2
The link beam in this Design Example is sized for stiffness to thus limit deflections
and link rotations under code loads. It therefore has greater strength than required
102
Design Example 2
5f.
2213.10.2
Check to assure that the beam flanges are compact to prevent flange buckling.
12.44"
52
bf
=
= 6.0
=
2t f
2 (1.035")
Fy
52
= 7.36
50 ksi
o.k.
5g.
Link length.
The length of the link will determine whether the link yields in shear or in bending.
To ensure shear yielding behavior, the link beams have been limited to lengths less
than 3 M s Vs .
V s = .55 F y dtw = 390.2 kips
e 1.3 M s = 55.5 in.
Vs
2213.4.2
[Popov, Englehardt, and Ricles]
3
M s = Z x F y = (333 in. ) (50 ksi) = 16,650 kip-in.
2213.4.2
For frame stiffness, drift, and rotation control purposes at the second level, use
e = 46 in. Thus:
eVs (46" ) (390.2 kips)
=
= 1.08
Ms
16,650 kip in.
o.k.
5h.
The summation of story forces down to level 3, Fi = V3 in Table 2-4, (the sum of
level shears from the roof to level 3) is 666k (476k on an ASD basis). The ASD
frame forces in level 2 at the left connection and right connection are
F2 L = 31.1 k 1.4 = 22.2 k and F2 L = 23.3 k 1.4 = 16.7 k . The link beam outside
the link must be checked for combined bending, plus axial loads. The link must be
checked for bending plus axial loads using the flanges only (because the web is
assumed to have yielded in shear and not capable of carrying axial load).
103
Design Example 2
The axial force can be factored up to account for actual link design overstrength,
. For this link, = 1.62 and the link axial force can be factored to be 4.5 kips.
5i.
The maximum d/tw ratio permitted for compact beam sections is dependent on the
axial load in the beam. Wide flange sections listed in the AISC W shapes tables
(AISC-ASD) have compact webs for all combinations of axial stress when the
yield strength is less than the tabulated values of F y .
If a beam section is chosen that does not have a compact web for all axial loads, the
section should be checked using allowable stress design of UBC Chapter 22,
Division V, Table B5.1 of (AISC-ASD). The web should be compact along the full
length of the beam. The UBC does not allow doubler plates to reduce d/tw
requirements for a link beam (see 2213.10.5). For the W 21 132 beam at the
second level of EBF4:
dt w = 33.6
A = 38.8 in.2
Maximum axial force in link beam outside the link:
V 3
666 kips
+ 31.1 kips
+ F 2L
2
2
=
= 260 kips
P 2L =
1.4
1.4
fa=
fa
Fy
104
Design Example 2
For f a 0.16 F y , the allowable d/tw to prevent local buckling is determined from
the equation below.
d
tw
f
640
l 3.74 a =
F y
Fy
6.7 ksi
640
l 3.74
= 45.1in.3
50 ksi
50 ksi
5j.
This calculation is made to check the combined bending plus axial strength of the
link (using loads anticipated to yield the link with the link design overstrength
factor, = 1.62 ).
P2,link = 2.8 k (1.62) = 4.5 kips
M 2,link = VS , 2
)(
M 2,link
Zf
4.5 k
8,975 ksi
+
= 33.7 ksi 50 ksi
2
2 12.875 in.
267.7 in.3
5k.
2213.10.3
The strength of the link is used to establish the minimum strength required of
elements outside the link. The link shear strength Vs was determined using the web
area d/tw, of the beam. When a beam has reached flexural capacity, shear in the link
may be less than the shear strength of the section. If this is the case, the flexural
capacity of the section will limit the shear capacity of the link. Section 2213.10.3
requires that the flexural capacity of the section, reduced for axial stress, be
considered as a possible upper limit of the link capacity. This will be checked
below.
105
Design Example 2
Vs = 390.2 kips
M rs = Z x f y f a
fa =
P2,link
2 Af
2213.10.3
4.5 k
= 0.17 ksi
2 12.875 in.2
Z x = 333 in.4
The controlling shear capacity is the least of Vs or Vrs . In this case, Vs = 390 kips
and Vrs = 721 kips . Therefore the controlling shear capacity is 390 kips.
Thus, the controlling mode of yielding is shear in the link, because the shear
required to yield the beam in bending will not be developed.
5l.
2313.10.18
Section 2213.10.18 requires lateral braces for the top and bottom flanges at the
ends of the link beams. The maximum interval l u ,max is determined below.
l u ,max = 76
bf
Fy
= 76
2313.10.18
Therefore the beam bracing at 10 ft 0 in. is adequate. (Note: the composite steel
deck and lightweight concrete fill is not considered effective in bracing the top
flange.)
5m.
2213.10.13
The beam outside the link is required to resist 130 percent of the bending, plus
axial forces generated in the link beam. The combined beam bending plus axial
interaction equations are referenced from AISC-ASD, Section N. Note that the
ASD version of capacity design is being used because the beam is being checked
under forces generated with a yielding link element in shear.
Forces are from a hand evaluation of EBF frame behavior and from computer
model analysis:
106
Design Example 2
V link e
+ 1.3M DL = 1.3 (8,974 k-in.) + 1.3 (188.4 k-in.) = 11,912 k-in.
2
(1.0)(120") = 41.0
(1.0)(150") = 16.4
kl
ry
kl
rx
2.93"
9.12"
Fay
( kl / ry ) 2
( 41.0) 2
F
1
50 ksi
y
1
2
2C c 2
2(107)
=
=
= 25.7 ksi
3
5 3 ( 41.0) (41.0) 3
5 3 ( kl / ry ) (kl / ry )
+
3 8 (107) 8 (107) 3
3
8C c
8C c 3
AISC-ASD E2
107
Design Example 2
12 2 E
23 kl / ry
)2
AISC-ASD E2
AISC-ASD E2
AISC-ASD N4,
AISC-ASD N4
AISC-ASD N4
23
23
Pe = Fe' A = (88.8 ksi ) 38.8 in.2 = 6,603 kips
12
12
ASD axial yielding load:
Maximum moment that can be resisted by the member in the absence of axial load:
AISC-ASD N4
564 kips
0.85 (11,912 k in.)
Cm M
+
=
1,695 kips
Pbu
564 kips
1 M m
1 16,650 k in.
Pe
6,603 kips
AISC-ASD (N4-2)
108
o.k.
Design Example 2
P
Py
564 kips
11,912 k in.
M
=
+
1.18 M p
1,940 kips
1.18 (16,650 k in.)
AISC-ASD (N4-3)
5n.
Beam stiffeners.
2213.10.7
There are two types of stiffeners required in links: link stiffeners at ends at brace
connections and intermediate stiffeners (Figures 2-7 and 2-11).
Link end stiffeners.
Full depth web stiffeners are required on both sides of the link beam at the brace
connections. The stiffeners are used to prevent web buckling and to ensure ductile
shear yielding of the web.
The stiffeners shall have a combined width not less than bf - 2tw and a thickness not
less than 0.75t w or 3/8 inch. For the W 21 132 beam
B f 2t w = 12.440"2 (.650") = 11.14" use 2 5.625"
2213.10.10
Section 2310.10.8 requires intermediate full depth web stiffeners (see Part 7,
Figure 2-7) for either of the following conditions:
1.
2.
Where link beam strength is controlled by flexure and the shear determined
by applying the reduced flexural strength, M rs exceeds 0.45F y dt w .
Therefore, intermediate web stiffeners are required for this Design Example.
109
Design Example 2
The spacing limits are a function of the link rotation per 2310.10.9. For a link
rotation 0.09 radians, the maximum allowed, the spacing shall not exceed
38t w d w 5 . For link rotation of 0.03 radians, the spacing shall not exceed
56t w d w 5 . Linear interpolation may be used between link rotations of 0.03 and
0.09 radians. Thus,
38t w
dw
21.83"
= 38 (.650")
= 20.33 in.
5
5
2213.10.9
56tw
dw
21.83"
= 56 (.650")
= 32.03 in.
5
5
2213.10.9
Since the link rotation is 0.088 radians for the beam, interpolation must be used to
determine the maximum spacing of intermediate stiffeners. This is shown below.
0.090 rad 0.088 rad
Fillet welds connecting the web stiffener to the web shall develop a stiffener force of:
Ast F y = (5.625" .375")(50 ksi ) = 105.5 kips
The minimum size of fillet weld, per AISC Table J2.4, is -inch to the link web
and 5/16 in. to the link flange. Using E70XX electrodes and 5/16-inch fillet welds
each side, the weld capacity is 1.7 allowable. The required weld length is
1required =
105.5 kips
(70 ksi )(1.7 )(2 5 16")(.707 ) = 6.7 in.
.3
Therefore, 5/16 in. fillet welds, both sides of the stiffener, at the flanges and the
web are adequate.
110
Design Example 2
Fillet welds connecting the web stiffener to the flanges shall develop a stiffener
force of
Ast F y / 4 = (5.625".375")(50 ksi ) / 4 = 26.4 kips
1, required =
26.4 kips
(70 ksi )(1.7 )(2 5 16")(.707 ) = 1.7 in.
.3
Therefore, 5/16-inch fillet welds, both sides of the stiffener, at the flanges are
adequate.
5o.
Tables 2-7a through 2-7g presents tabular calculations that show the results from
procedures from Parts 5a through 5s applied to all beams in the frame EBF4. The
link beam design for all levels is as shown below in tabular form following the
equations given above (each link beam at each level of the frame has a row
calculation which extends through the full table):
Level
Link
A
(in.2)
Zx
(in.3)
br
(in.)
tr
(in.)
d
(in.)
tw
(in.)
e
(in.)
a
(in.)
h
(in.)
Af
(in.2)
Zf
(in.3)
(ksi)
R
5
4
3
2
W16x77
W18X86
W18X97
W18X97
W21X132
22.60
25.30
28.50
28.50
38.80
150.0
186.0
211.0
211.0
333.0
10.30
11.09
11.15
11.15
12.44
0.76
0.77
0.87
0.87
1.04
16.52
18.39
18.59
18.59
21.83
0.46
0.48
0.54
0.54
0.65
24
34
36
36
46
168
163
162
162
157
144
144
144
144
168
15.6
17.1
19.4
19.4
25.8
123.3
150.5
171.8
171.8
267.7
50
50
50
50
50
Vs
Ms
bf 2tf
R
5
4
3
2
206.7
242.7
273.5
273.5
390.2
3.16
2.02
1.69
1.44
1.62
7,500
9,300
10,550
10,550
16,650
6.77
7.20
6.41
6.41
6.01
Compact
1.3
Flange Compact
Flange
Limit
M s Vs
Results
bf 2tf
7.35
7.35
7.35
7.35
7.35
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
47.2
49.8
50.1
50.1
55.5
fa
fa Fy
dtw
4.14
6.33
7.36
8.53
6.71
0.08
0.13
0.15
0.17
0.13
36.3
38.3
34.7
34.7
33.6
Compact Compact
web
Web
Limit dtw Results
62.5
47.7
40.7
36.3
45.1
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
111
Design Example 2
0
229.2
420.9
566.6
666.3
Level
at
level
(kips)
Pmax
Link
Beam
(kips)
fa
(ksi)
Comb.
fa
Vs
Link
(psi) Stress (kips)
(psi)
M rs
(k-in.)
Vrs
(kips)
Vmin
(kips)
lu
Max
(in.)
131.0
109.5
83.3
57.0
31.1
94
160
210
243
260
4.14
6.33
7.36
8.53
6.71
16.4
13.7
10.4
7.1
3.9
0.75
0.64
0.50
0.44
0.29
7.388
9.181
10.444
10.456
16.553
615.7
540.0
580.2
580.9
719.7
206.7
242.7
273.5
273.5
390.2
110.7
119.2
119.8
119.8
133.7
1.00
1.12
1.31
1.69
2.70
785.9
2.044.5
2.914.1
3.426.8
5.525.6
6.7
13.9
17.2
20.2
20.8
206.7
242.7
273.5
273.5
390.2
P
(kips)
M = Vs e 2
(k-in.)
Link
Beam
Overstress
Factor
Pcomp
Mcomp
DL
(kips)
R
5
4
3
2
94
160
210
243
260
2,480
4,127
4,923
4,923
8,975
3.16
2.02
1.69
1.44
1.62
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
10
8.73
11.2
10
11
"DL"
(k-in.)
Beam
Overstress
Factor
Pbu
Design
(kips)
208.8
226.8
213.6
200.4
188.4
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
397
431
475
467
564
M bu
Design
(kips)
3,496
5,660
6,678
6,661
11,912
Section
A
(in.2)
Z
(in.3)
R
5
4
3
2
W16x77
W18X86
W18X97
W18X97
W21X132
22.6
25.3
28.5
28.5
38.8
150
186
211
211
333
Fy
ry
(ksi)
Lu
(ft)
rx
(in.)
kl ry
Cc
(ksi)
kl r y C c
(in.)
50
50
50
50
50
10
10
10
10
10
5.89
7.77
7.82
7.82
9.12
1.92
2.63
2.65
2.65
2.93
62.5
45.6
45.3
45.3
41.0
107.0
107.0
107.0
107.0
107.0
0.58
0.43
0.42
0.42
0.38
Cm
P
Design
(k)
M
Design
(k-in.)
AISCASD
(N4-2)
AISC
ASD
(N4-3)
Results
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
397
431
475
467
564
3,496
5,660
6,678
6,661
11,912
0.98
0.99
1.00
0.99
1.00
0.75
0.86
0.87
0.86
0.90
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
Fa
(ksi)
F'e
(ksi)
Pcr
(k)
Pe
(k)
Py
M m ,M p
(k)
(k-in.)
R
5
4
3
2
22.3
25.0
25.1
25.1
25.7
38.2
71.7
72.8
72.8
89.0
856
1,076
1,214
1,214
1,695
1,655
3,478
3,978
3,978
6,620
1,130
1,265
1,425
1,425
1,940
7500
9300
10550
10550
16650
112
Level
Delta S
Deflection (in.)
Delta M
Drift (in.)
Rotation
(rad)
Results
R
5
4
3
2
1.01
0.87
0.69
0.46
0.24
0.69
0.88
1.13
1.08
1.18
0.0715
0.0649
0.0783
0.0749
0.0548
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
Design Example 2
5p.
Brace design.
2213.10.13
The braces are required to be designed for 1.3 times the earthquake forces in the
braces, plus 1.3 times the gravity loads. There is a misprint in 97 UBC
2213.10.13, where the brace and beam overstrength factor is both 1.5 and 1.3.
However, the factor 1.5 was from the 1994 UBC and should have been deleted.
The factor 1.3 should be used.
PE = 1.3 Pcomputer due to
E
loads
1.4
E
loads
1.4
Using plastic design procedures outlined in AISC Section N, obtaining forces from
a computer analysis, and showing calculations in tabular form. Design forces for
braces ( P and M ) are calculated as 1.3 times seismic forces plus 1.3 times
gravity forces. Column shear forces are not a controlling factor and are not shown
for brevity. Tables 2-8a through 2-8c show tabular design of braces for EBF4 at all
levels.
PE
E/1.4
ME
E/1.4
Brace
Overstress
Factor
PD
D
MD
D
Brace
Overstress
Factor
P
Design
M
Design
5
4
3
2
1
106
194
262
302
372
10.2
11.7
23.4
26.7
38.5
3.16
2.02
1.69
1.44
1.62
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
11.8
14.6
14.7
14.4
13.9
5.1
4.4
4.3
4.3
3.4
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
519.5
609.3
686.0
672.4
927.2
55.9
42.0
65.7
64.0
98.9
kl ry
Cc
(ksi)
kl / ry / Cc
74.4
73.1
72.5
71.0
69.4
107.0
107.0
107.0
107.0
107.0
Brace
Section
A
(in.2)
Z
(in.3)
5
4
3
2
1
W12X87
W12x87
W12x87
W12X106
W12X120
25.60
25.60
25.60
31.20
35.30
132.0
132.0
132.0
164.0
186.0
Fy
ry
(ksi)
L
(ft)
rx
(in.)
(in.)
50
50
50
50
50
20.5
20.2
20.2
20.2
19.9
5.34
5.38
5.43
5.57
5.66
3.31
3.32
3.34
3.41
3.44
0.70
0.68
0.68
0.66
0.65
113
Design Example 2
5q.
Fa
F' e
Pcr
Pe
Py
M m ,M p
(ksi)
(ksi)
(k)
(k)
(k)
(k-in.)
20.1
20.3
20.5
20.7
21.0
262.1
262.1
262.1
262.1
262.1
875.2
885.6
890.8
1100.5
1262.8
12,860
12,860
12,860
15,673
17,732
1280
1280
1280
1560
1765
6600
6600
6600
8200
9300
Cm
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
P
Design
M
Design
(k)
(k-in.)
450.2
528.0
594.5
582.8
803.5
659.0
493.7
778.7
757.5
1178.6
AISC
AISC
(N4-2)
(N4-3)
0.60
0.66
0.77
0.61
0.75
0.35
0.41
0.46
0.37
0.46
Column design.
Results
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
2213.10.14
The columns are required to resist 1.25 times the strength developed in the links to
assure that the yielding mechanism is the link beams (Section 2213.10.14). Design
forces ( P and M ) are calculated as 1.25 times (frame analysis) seismic forces
plus 1.25 times gravity forces. Column shear forces are not a controlling factor and
are not shown for brevity. Tables 2-9a through 2-9c show tabular design of
columns for EBF4 at all levels
PE
E/1.4
ME
E/1.4
km5
4
3
2
1
106
3.16
2.02
1.69
372
10.2
1.25
1.25
1.25
38.5
11.8
14.6
14.7
1.62
Brace
Overstress
Factor
5.1
4.4
4.3
1.25
PD
D
MD
D
1.25
1.25
1.25
13.9
4.3
3.4
Brace
Overstress
factor
1.25
1.25
P
Design
M
Design
432.9
507.7
571.7
560.3
772.6
46.6
35.0
54.8
53.3
82.4
114
Level
Column
Section
A
(in.2)
Z
(in.3)
5
4
3
2
1
W12X65
W12X65
W12X65
W12X87
W12X87
19.10
19.10
19.10
25.60
25.60
96.8
96.8
96.8
132.0
132.0
Fy
ry
(ksi)
L
(ft)
rx
(in.)
(in.)
50
50
50
50
50
12
12
12
12
14
5.28
5.28
5.28
5.38
5.38
5.67
5.67
5.67
5.72
5.72
kl ry
Cc
(ksi)
kl / ry / Cc
2.48
2.48
25.4
25.2
29.4
107.0
107.0
107.0
107.0
107.0
0.02
0.02
0.24
0.24
0.27
Design Example 2
5r.
Fa
F' e
Pcr
Pe
Py
M m ,M p
(ksi)
(ksi)
(k)
(k)
(k)
(k-in.)
29.8
29.8
27.7
27.7
27.2
262.1
262.1
262.1
262.1
262.1
968
968
899
1,206
1,185
955
955
955
1280
1280
4840
4840
4840
6600
6600
9,594
9,594
9,594
12,860
12,860
Cm
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
P
Design
M
Design
(k)
(k-in.)
432.9
507.7
571.7
560.3
772.6
559.4
420.2
657.5
639.9
989.0
AISC
AISC
(N4-2)
(N4-3)
0.55
0.60
0.76
0.55
0.79
0.45
0.53
0.60
0.44
0.60
Results
In EBF design, special consideration should be given to the foundation design. The
basis for design of the EBF is that the yielding occurs in the EBF links. Thus, all
other elements should have the strength to develop the link beam yielding
strengths.
The code does not require the foundation design to be capable of developing the
link beam strengths. However, if only a minimum code foundation design is
performed, the foundation will generally not develop the EBF link beam strengths,
and yielding will occur in the foundation. This is not consistent with the design
philosophy for EBF frames.
The SEAOC Blue Book recommends that the foundation be designed to develop
the strength of the EBF frame. The intention is to have adequate foundation
strength and stability to ensure the development of link beam yield mechanisms to
achieve the energy dissipation anticipated in the eccentric braced frames. A static
pushover analysis of an EBF frame can give a good indication of the foundation
adequacy.
5s.
Beams
Link Lengths
Roof
5
4
3
2
1
W16X77
W18X86
W18X97
W18X97
W21X132
24"
34"
36"
36"
46"
Columns
Braces
W12X65
W12X65
W12X65
W12X87
W12X87
W12X87
W12X87
W12X87
W12X106
W12X120
115
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
Design Example 2
6.
In the 1997 UBC, a designer has a choice of whether to design using allowable
stress design (ASD) methods or whether to use load and resistance factor design
(LRFD) methods. In part 5, the ASD method is illustrated. In part 6, the LRFD
method is illustrated. The results are slightly different, depending on the method
chosen. In this part, the frame EBF4 that was designed to ASD requirements in Part
5 is now designed to LRFD requirements of AISC-Seismic.
LRFD design provisions for EBF frames are contained in Section 15 of the AISC
document, Seismic Provisions for Structural Steel Buildings, published in 1997.
This document is commonly known as AISC-Seismic. Note that the Seismic
Provisions for Structural Steel Buildings, 1992 edition, is included in the AISCLRFD Manual, Part 6, which is adopted by reference in the code in Chapter 22,
Division II, 2206. However, the 1997 AISC-Seismic provisions have been
updated and are recommended in the SEAOC Blue Book, Section 702.
116
Design Example 2
6a.
The link shear strength Vn can be found from the minimum values of V p or
2 M p e . The values for V p are calculated as follows:
(d 2t f )t w 0.90V(0i,link
.60)
AISC-Seismic 15.2d
Fy
V p = 0.60 F y t w (d 2 t f )
AISC-Seismic 15.2d
M p = ZxFy
Preliminary beam sizes are determined as shown in Table 2-11. Note that seismic
forces for LRFD procedures use both E h and E v . The E v seismic force is additive
to dead load D and is included in the load combination of Equation (12-5).
1.2 D + f1l + 1.0 E
(12-5)
E = E h + E v
Ev = 0.5Ca ID = 0.5(0.53)(1.0 )D = 0.265 D
Substituting for E h , E v , and f1 in Equation (12-5)
1.2 D + 0.5l + 1.0(E h + E v )
= 1.2 D + 0.5l + 1.0(1.13E h + 0.265D )
= 1.465D + 0.5l + 1.13E h
Tables 2-11a through 2-11c show preliminary link analysis and sizing (LRFD).
Table 2-11a. Design seismic forces at EBF frame
Level
R
5
4
3
2
Story
Forces
229
192
146
100
54
Frame Forces, E h
Frame Forces, E h
Left
Right
C, T link
Fil
Fir
Vi
131.0
109.5
83.2
57.0
31.1
98.2
82.1
62.4
42.7
23.3
16.4
13.7
10.4
7.1
3.9
131.0
109.5
83.2
57.0
31.1
98.2
82.1
62.4
42.7
23.3
229.2
420.9
566.6
666.2
720.6
Fi
Vi 2
229.2
191.7
145.7
99.7
54.4
114.6
210.4
283.3
333.1
360.3
117
Design Example 2
Story
Height
R
5
4
3
2
12
12
12
12
15
Fi 2
114.6
95.8
72.8
49.8
27.2
Fi 2
114.6
95.8
72.8
49.8
27.2
Vli
105.8
194.3
261.5
279.8
415.8
(d 2t f )t w
Size
tw
tf
W14X38
W16X89
W21X111
W21X122
W27X178
14.10
16.75
21.51
21.68
27.81
0.31
0.53
0.55
0.60
0.73
0.52
0.88
0.88
0.96
1.19
min.
3.92
7.19
9.68
10.36
15.40
(d 2t f )t w
Results
Zx
R
5
4
3
2
4.05
7.88
10.87
11.86
18.44
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
61.50
175.00
279.00
307.00
567.00
Mp
Vp
1.3
M p Vp
1.6
M p Vp
Link
e
Ratio
M p Vp
CDR
3,075
8,750
13,950
15,350
28,350
109
213
293
320
498
36.5
53.5
61.8
62.3
74.0
45.0
65.8
76.1
76.7
91.1
32
48
56
56
66
1.26
1.30
1.31
1.30
1.29
1.15
1.22
1.25
1.27
1.33
1.03
1.09
1.12
1.14
1.20
For the first (ground level) story, the EBF link beam design will be based on use of
a W 27 178 link beam at Level 2. Note that 15.2 of AISC-Seismic limits the
yield strength of the link beam to F y = 50 ksi .
6b.
Link rotation.
The frame displacement at the second level, S 2 , was determined from a separate
computer analysis (not shown) using the design base shear without .
S 2 = 0.28 in.
The corresponding inelastic displacement, M 2 may be estimated from a static
analysis by the following formula:
M = .7 R s = .7(7 )0.28" = 1.37 in.
118
(30-17)
Design Example 2
The link rotation is computed as a function of the frame story drift and frame
geometry. For a frame of story height h , bay width l , link length e, and
dimensions a = l e 2 , the link rotation may be calculated by the following
formula. Link rotations, , must be limited to 0.080 radians per AISC-Seismic
15.2g.
=
M
2a 1.37"
2 (147 ")
1 +
=
1 +
= 0.042 radians 0.080
e 180 "
H
66
o.k.
Comment: The above formula makes the assumption that all deformation occurs
within the link rotation at a particular level. It has been observed that there is
significant contribution to deformations from column and brace elongation and
shortening. A more accurate analysis of link rotation can be made looking at joint
displacements and calculating rotations based on relative joint displacements.
Another simple method is to perform an analysis using very strong column and
brace section properties in the model and force all deformations into the link beam
for purposes of evaluating the link rotations.
6c.
AISC-Seismic 15.2d
Vn = 0.9 (0.60 )F y t w d 2t f = 0.9 (0.6 )(50 ksi )(.73")[27.8"2 (1.19")] = 498 kips
2 M p
e
0.9 (2 )M p
e
0.9 (2) F y Z x
e
Vn = 498 kips
Vn =
498 kips
= 553 kips
0.9
The design overstrength factor for this link beam is calculated as follows:
=
Vn
553 kips
=
= 1.33
Vi ,link 416 kips
119
Design Example 2
The minimum link design shear overstrength ratio is controlled by the factor.
Thus, the minimum is min = 1.0 = 1.0 0.9 = 1.11 . The significance of the
overstrength ratio is that the link will not yield until seismic forces overcome the
link yield point. The overstrength factor is a relationship between code forces
and design overstrength forces which will likely yield the link. Note that the
factor does not include the R y factor for expected yield stress of the steel.
The link beam in this Design Example has been sized for strength and stiffness. In
beams above the level under discussion, it was found necessary to add cover plates
for the beams outside the links (for increased beam capacity outside the link). The
attempt was made to balance the design between good ratios of Mp /Vp of
approximately 1.3 and the requirement for cover plates outside the link. It was
decided to use cover plates to meet strength requirements for EBF beams outside
the link to maintain desired ratios of Mp /Vp. The trade-off is to lessen the ratio of
Mp /Vp and not require cover plates. It is believed that the performance of the link is
more important than the cover plate requirement, and thus it was not possible to
size beams to meet requirements outside the link without beam cover plates for this
configuration of EBF frame.
6d.
Check the W 27 178 beam to ensure that the flanges are compact to prevent
flange buckling.
14.09"
52
bf
=
= 5.92
=
2 t f 2(1.19")
Fy
6e.
52
= 7.35
50 ksi
o.k.
Link length.
The length of the link will determine whether the link yields in shear or in bending
deformations. To ensure the desired shear yielding behavior (see discussion in Part
5b), the link beams have been limited to lengths less than 1.3Mp /Vp. From part 6c,
Vp and Mp are calculated:
V p = 553 kips
3
M p = Z x F y = 567 in. (50 ksi ) = 28,350 kip-in.
120
Design Example 2
o.k.
6f.
The strength of the link is used to establish the minimum strength required of
elements outside the link. The link shear strength Vp was determined using the web
area (d-2tf) of the beam. When the beam has reached flexural capacity, shear in the
link may be less than the shear strength of the section. If this is the case, the
flexural capacity of the section will limit the shear capacity of the link. AISCSeismic 15.2f requires that the shear strength of the section be the minimum of
shear yielding strength or shear required for plastic moment yielding behavior.
V p = 553 kips
2M p
e
6g.
2313.10.18
The limiting unbraced length for full plastic bending capacity, L p , is determined as
follows. Lateral beam braces for the top and bottom flanges at the ends of the link
beams are still required.
Lp =
300ry
F yf
300(3.26")
50 ksi
= 138.3" 11'6"
AISC-LRFD (F1-4)
Therefore, the beam bracing at 10 ft.-0 in. is adequate. (Note: the composite steel
deck and lightweight concrete fill is not considered effective in bracing the top
flange.)
121
Design Example 2
6h.
The summation of story forces down to level 3, Fi = V3 in Table 2-4 (the sum of
level shears from the roof to Level 3) is 666 k. The frame forces in Level 2 at the
left connection and right connection are F2 L = 31.1 k and F2 R = 23.3 k .
If the required axial strength of the link Pu is equal to or less than 0.15 Py , the
effect of axial force on the link design shear strength need not be considered.
Therefore, the axial force in the link is:
C link = T link =
The maximum axial stress in the link must be checked for the requirements of
15.2e of AISC-Seismic:
fa =
Therefore, the effect of axial force on the link design shear strength need not be
considered.
6i.
AISC-Seismic 9.4
122
Design Example 2
666 kips
Pu
484kips
=
= 0.21 0.125
b Py 0.90 (50 ksi ) 52.30 in.2
hc / t w = 32.9 58.8
o.k.
6j.
The combined bending plus axial strength of the link must be checked and
compared with the yield stress. In the link, axial and bending stresses are resisted
entirely by flanges.
Pu = 3.9 kips ( ) = 3.9 kips(1.33) = 5.2 kips
Pu
364 kips
=
= 0.14 0.15
Py (50 ksi ) 52.30 in.2
AISC-Seismic 15.2f
123
Design Example 2
)(
6k.
Link beams have difficulty resisting the link beam moments increased by 1.1 and
Ry when using a lower bound strength not including Ry. Although AISC-Seismic
allows the LRFD design strength to be increased by Ry, it is not very clear how
AISC-Seismic had intended it to be performed. In conversation with
representatives of AISC-Seismic, it was conveyed to the author of this Design
Example that the intention was simply to increase LRFD design strengths (Pn, Mn)
by an Ry factor. It was not the intention of the AISC-Seismic subcommittee to
increase Fy by Ry and carry those values through all the LRFD design equations.
The solution in this Design Example has the beam outside the link resisting the
entirety of the link beam moment. A more refined analysis can be performed where
the brace contributes to the resistance of moment, which would reduce the moment
on the beam outside the link. The analysis in this Design Example includes the use
of flange cover plates to increase the bending capacity of the beam outside the link.
The beam outside the link is required to resist 110 percent of the bending and axial
forces corresponding to the link beam yield, using its nominal strength Ry. The
combined beam bending plus axial interaction equations are referenced from
AISC-LRFD Section H. Axial load analysis is referenced from AISC-LRFD
Section E and bending analysis is referenced from AISC-LRFD Section F.
The steps below yield forces from the hand evaluation of EBF frame behavior and
from the computer model (not shown).
Axial force in beam outside link is:
PE = 364 kips
From computer model, the load combination of Equation (12-5), including
E v = 0.265 D , is:
1.2 D + 0.265 D + 0.5l + 1.0 E h
1.465D + 0.5l ; PD +L = 18 kips
124
Design Example 2
AISC-Seismic 15.6a
Pu = 1.1R y PE + 1.1PD + L
From computer analysis, load combination Equation (12-5):
1.2 D + 0.265 D + 0.5l + 1.0 Eh
M D + L = 307 kip-in.
Mu=
1.1R y V p e
2
+ 1.1M D + L
= 26,443 kip-in.
Beam section properties.
Combined section properties are given in Table 2-12, the reader should understand
how to convert typical beam section properties to those with cover plates:
The beam at Level 2 does not require cover plates. The beams at Levels 3-Roof all
require cover plates and thus have transformed section properties for use in the
following equations.
For W 27 170 beam without cover plates:
A = 52.3 in.2
Z x = 567 in.3
Z f = 446 in.3
I x = 6,990 in.4
S x = 503 in.3
ry = 3.26 in.
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
125
Design Example 2
I y = 555 in.4
J = 19.5 in.4
C w = 98,300 in.6
X 1 = 2,543
X 2 = 0.00375
Beam slenderness parameters:
kl
ry
(1.0)(120") = 36.8
3.26"
kl Fy
36.8
(50 ksi ) = 0.487
=
r E
3.1416 29,000 ksi
AISC-LRFD (E2-4)
2
2
Fcr = 0.658lc Fy = 0.658.487
AISC-LRFD (E2-2)
c = 0.85
Nominal axial strength is calculated as follows:
AISC-LRFD (E2-1)
AISC-Seismic 15.6b
AISC-LRFDF1.1
AISC-LRFD (F1-1)
Design Example 2
Lb L p
M p
M n = C b M p ( M p M r )
L
L
p
r
AISC-LRFD (F1-2)
C b = 1.0
Unbraced length:
Lb = 120 in.
Limiting laterally unbraced length for full plastic yielding:
Lp =
300ry
F yf
300(3.26)
50 ksi
= 138 in.
AISC-LRFD (F1-2)
ry X 1
FL
1 + 1 + X 2 FL 2
AISC-LRFD (F1-6)
AISC-LRFD (F1-7)
Sx
X2 = 4
EGJA
2
Cw S x
I y GJ
AISC-LRFD (F1-8)
2
AISC-LRFD (F1-9)
FL is the smaller of the yield stress in the flange minus compressive residual
stresses (10 ksi for rolled shapes) or web yield stress.
AISC-LRFD F1.2a
FL = (50 ksi 10 ksi ) = 40 ksi
Lr =
ry X 1
FL
1 + 1 + X 2 FL 2 =
(3.26)(2,543)
(40 ksi )
127
Design Example 2
M n = Cb M p M p M r
) LLb LLp
120"138"
= 1.0 28,350 (28,350 20,108)
396"138"
M n = 28,350 k-in.
R y M n = 1.3 (28,350 k-in.) = 36,855 k-in.
Comparison of lateral torsional buckling moment with plastic yield moment
indicates that plastic yield moment is the controlling yield behavior. AISC-LRFD
Section H, combined axial plus bending interaction equations are as follows:
For the case:
Pu
0.2
c R y Pn
AISC-LRFD (H1-1a)
Pu
8 M ux
+
1.0
c R y Pn 9 b R y M nx
For the case:
Pu
< 0.2
c R y Pn
AISC-LRFD (H1-1b)
Pu
M ux
+
1.0
2 c R y Pn b R y M nx
Thus, for this Design Example:
Pu
712 kips
=
= 0.27 0.2
c R y Pn 0.85(3,078 kips )
128
Design Example 2
Pu
8 M ux
712 kips
8 26,443 k in.
= 0.98 1.0
+
=
+
c R y Pn 9 b R y M nx (0.85)(3,078 kips ) 9 0.90 (36,855 k in.)
o.k.
Therefore, W 27 178 beam outside the link is okay. The EBF beams above Level
2 require cover plates and thus utilize combined section properties in the above
equations.
6l.
Beam stiffeners.
AISC-Seismic 15.3
There are two types of stiffeners required in links: 1.) link stiffeners at ends at
brace connections; and 2.) intermediate stiffeners. These are shown in Figure 2-7.
Link end stiffeners.
Full depth web stiffeners are required on both sides of the link beam at the brace
connections. The stiffeners are used to prevent web buckling and to ensure ductile
shear yielding of the web.
The stiffeners shall have a combined width not less than bf - 2tw and a thickness not
less than 0.75t w or 3/8 inch, whichever is larger. For the W 27 178 beam:
b f 2t w = 14.09"2(0.73") = 12.63" use 2 6.375"
AISC-Seismic 15.3a
AISC-Seismic 15.3b requires intermediate full depth web stiffeners (Figure 2-7)
where link lengths are 5 V p M p or less.
Where link lengths are 1.6 V p M p or less, the spacing shall not exceed
30t w d w 5 for link rotation of 0.08 radians and 52t w d w 5 for link rotations of
0.02 radians. Linear interpolation may be used between link rotations of 0.02 and
0.08 radians. Thus,
129
Design Example 2
30tw
d
27.81"
= 30(0.73")
= 16.33 in.
5
5
AISC-Seismic 15.3b
52t w
d
27.81"
= 52(0.73")
= 32.43 in.
5
5
AISC-Seismic 15.3b
Since the link rotation is 0.040 radians for the beam, interpolation must be used to
determine the maximum spacing of intermediate stiffeners. This is shown below.
0.080 rad 0.040 rad
AISC-Seismic 15.3c
The minimum size of fillet weld, per AISC-LRFD Table J2.4, is -inch to the link
web and 5/16-inch to the link flange. Using E70XX electrodes and 5/16-inch fillet
welds each side, the weld capacity is 0.6FEXX. The required weld length on the
beam web is:
1required =
199 kips
= 10.72 in.
0.60(70 ksi )(2 5 16")(.707 )
Therefore, use 5/16-inch fillet welds, both sides of the stiffener, at flanges and web.
Note: One-fourth of the above required weld is required at the flanges.
130
Design Example 2
6m.
Tables 2-12a through 2-12h present tabular calculations that show the results from
procedures in Parts 6a through 6l applied to all beams in the frame EBF4. The link
beam design for all levels is as shown below in tabular form following the
equations given above (each row/level is a continuation of the table above).
Level
Link
Beam
Fy
bf
tf
tw
t w (d 2t r )
Size
R
5
4
3
2
W14X38
W16X89
W21X111
W21X122
W27X178
32
48
56
56
66
164
156
152
152
147
144
144
144
144
168
50
50
50
50
50
11.20
26.20
32.70
35.90
52.30
6.77
10.37
12.34
12.39
14.09
0.52
0.88
0.88
0.96
1.19
14.10
16.75
21.51
21.68
27.81
0.31
0.53
0.55
0.60
0.73
4.05
7.88
10.87
11.86
18.44
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
Link
Beam
Af
Zf
Zx
lx
Sx
rx
ly
Sy
ry
Cw
R
5
4
3
2
W14X38
W16X89
W21X111
W21X122
W27X178
7.0
18.1
21.6
23.8
33.5
47.4
144.0
222.8
246.5
446.2
61.5
175.0
279.0
307.0
567.0
385.0
1,300.0
2,670.0
2,960.0
6,990.0
54.6
155.0
249.0
273.0
502.0
5.86
7.04
9.04
9.08
11.56
26.7
163.0
274.0
305.0
555.0
7.89
31.45
44.41
49.23
78.81
1.54
2.49
2.89
2.91
3.26
0.80
5.45
6.83
8.98
19.50
1,230
10,200
29,200
32,700
98,300
Link
Beam
Plate
b
At
Zx
Zf
lx
Sx
ry
ly
Cw
X1
X2
R
5
4
3
2
W14X38
W16X89
W21X111
W21X122
W27X178
6
6
6
6
0
0.375
0.250
0.250
0.250
0.000
16
29
36
39
52
94
201
312
340
567
80
169
255
279
446
621
1517
3025
3321
6990
84
176
275
299
503
1.60
2.43
2.82
2.84
3.26
40
172
283
314
555
0.8
5.5
6.8
9.0
19.5
1,230
10,200
29,200
32,700
98,300
1,697
2,872
2,274
2,499
2,543
0.01065
0.00197
0.00533
0.00369
0.00375
109.4
212.6
293.4
320.1
497.8
Mp
Vp
Mp
b
b f
2t f
6.57
5.92
7.05
6.45
5.92
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
34.0
49.8
57.5
58.0
68.9
Pu
Py
Pu
Pn
tw
130.97
224.13
293.69
340.24
364.21
560.00
1,310.00
1,635.00
1,795.00
2,615.00
0.28
0.20
0.21
0.22
0.16
42.2
28.6
35.9
32.9
35.1
Comp. Comp.
Web
Web
Limits Results
55.5
57.5
57.2
56.9
58.5
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
131
Design Example 2
Fi
0 131.0
229.2 109.5
420.9 83.2
566.6 57.0
666.2 31.1
Pmax
Link
Beam
Plink
131.0
224.1
293.7
340.2
364.2
16.4 1,944.8
15.3 5,670.0
13.7 9,129.1
12.0 9,959.0
10.5 18,252.4
M link
Comb Allow.
Link
Link
Link
Result
Loads Stress
42.2
39.8
41.3
40.7
41.1
50
50
50
50
50
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
2M pa
2
Vu
Value
Lu
max.
2,780
8,558
13,504
14,680
28,794
156.4
320.9
434.1
471.8
785.3
106.4
209.5
288.7
314.3
492.9
1.14
1.17
1.18
1.17
1.16
72.8
111.4
132.6
133.2
151.4
Ry
Pbu
(kips)
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
217
403
542
638
712
Vpa
M pa
106.4
209.5
288.7
314.3
492.9
M u ,SEISMIC
131
224
294
340
364
Vp e 2
1,945
5,670
9,129
9,959
18,252
1.15
1.22
1.25
1.27
1.33
Beam Pu ,D +L M u ,D +L Beam
Overstr. 1.465D+ 1.465D+ Overstr.
Factor
Factor
0.5L
0.5L
1.10
1.10
1.10
1.10
1.10
2.0
12.0
17.0
17.4
17.6
342.0
359.0
303.0
318.0
307.0
1.10
1.10
1.10
1.10
1.10
Pbu
(k-in.)
3,157
8,503
13,388
14,591
26,439
Section
Lu
(ft)
kl r y
Fcr
(ksi)
Pn
(kips)
R y Pn
R
5
4
3
2
W14X38
W16X89
W21X111
W21X122
W27X178
10
10
10
10
10
75.0
49.4
42.6
42.2
36.8
0.991
0.653
0.563
0.558
0.487
33.14
41.82
43.78
43.89
45.28
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
520
1,221
1,563
1,707
2,368
676
1,587
2,032
2,219
3,078
(kips)
Table 2-12g. Flexural strength parameters and combined axial plus bending results
(LTB=lateral torsional buckling yield mode)
Level b
R
5
4
3
2
132
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
Mn = M p
(k-in.)
4,703
10,025
15,582
16,994
28,350
C b Lb L p
LTB (in.) (in.)
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
120
120
120
120
120
68
103
119
121
138
X1
X2
1,697
2,872
2,274
2,499
2,543
0.01065
0.00197
0.00533
0.00369
0.00375
40
40
40
40
40
Mn
LTB
(k-in.)
Mn
(k-in.)
Ry Mn
(k-in.)
Pu
R y Pn
5,064
12,703
20,241
22,093
36,855
0.38
0.30
0.31
0.34
0.27
FL
Lr
(ksi) (in.)
Mr
(k-in.)
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
Design Example 2
6n.
Level
Story
Drift
S
Story
M
(i.n)
h
(in.)
a
(in.)
e
(in.)
Rot
(rad)
R
5
4
3
2
1.21
1.01
0.78
0.53
0.28
0.20
0.23
0.25
0.25
0.28
0.98
1.13
1.23
1.23
1.37
144
144
144
144
180
164
156
152
152
147
32
48
56
56
66
0.0766
0.0587
0.0547
0.0547
0.0416
15.6, AISC-Seismic
The braces are required to be designed for 1.25R yV p times the yielding link
strength plus 1.25 times gravity load combinations.
PE = 1.25R y Pcomputer due to E h loads.
M E = 1.25 R yV p e / 2
Using strength design procedures outlined in AISC-LRFD Section H, obtaining
forces from a computer analysis, and showing calculations in tabular form
(Tables 2-13a through 2-13e), the design forces for braces ( P and M ) are
calculated. Column shear forces are not a controlling factor and are not shown for
the sake of brevity.
Level
Section
A
(in.2)
Zx
(in.3)
Sx
(in.3)
L
(ft)
rx
(in.)
(in.)
5
4
3
2
1
W12X87
W12X152
W12X210
W12X230
W12X252
26
45
62
68
74
132
243
348
386
428
118
209
292
321
353
18
18
18
18
19
5.38
5.66
5.88
5.98
6.06
3.07
3.19
3.28
3.31
3.34
kl r y
71.4
68.7
66.8
65.5
68.6
Fy
(ksi)
50
50
50
50
50
133
Design Example 2
Section
PE
ME
Overstr.
Factor
R
5
4
3
2
W12X87
W12X72
W12X79
W12X106
W12X120
150
276
378
446
565
1,512
3,036
3,744
4,200
3,996
1.15
1.22
1.25
1.27
1.33
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.25
Pgravity
M gravity
1.465D+
0.5L
1.465D+
0.5L
18.0
24.0
24.0
25.0
25.0
276.0
247.0
180.0
181.0
105.0
Overstr.
Factor
Ry
Pbu
design
M bu
design
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
303
575
796
953
1,253
3,168
6,309
7,811
8,903
8,770
Section
Lu
(ft)
kl r y
Fcr
(ksi)
Pn
(kips)
R
5
4
3
2
W12X87
W12X72
W12X79
W12X106
W12X120
18
18
18
18
19
71.4
68.7
66.8
65.5
68.6
0.943
0.908
0.883
0.865
0.906
34.45
35.40
36.08
36.55
35.46
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
881.9
1,582.4
2,229.5
2,474.5
2,627.3
X1
X2
FL
(k-in.)
Lr
Mr
(k-in.)
Mn
(k-in.)
5
4
3
2
b
(ksi)
Mn = M p
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
Lp
(k-in.)
Cb
(kips)
Lb
(in.)
(in.)
6,600.0
1.0
219
130
3,869
0.0006
40
459
4,720
6,092.5
12,150.0
17,400.0
19,300.0
21,400.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
219
219
217
229
135
139
140
142
3,225
3,524
4,650
5,231
0.0012
0.0008
0.0003
0.0002
40
40
40
40
423
460
572
639
8,360
11,680
12,840
14,120
11,045.1
15,974.5
18,158.5
20,120.9
134
Level
Section
Pu
Pn
AISC
LRFD
H1-1a
AISC
LRFD
H1-1b
5
4
3
2
1
W12X87
W12X152
W12X210
W12X230
W12X252
0.40
0.43
0.42
0.45
0.56
0.92
0.99
0.90
0.94
0.99
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
Design Example 2
6o.
AISC-Seismic 15.8
The design of the columns for frame EBF4 for the requirements of AISC-Seismic
is shown in Tables 2-14a through 2-14e. The columns are required to resist an axial
force corresponding to 1.1RyVn, which is the shear strength of the links to ensure
that the yielding mechanism is within the link beams. Design forces (P and P) are
calculated as 1.1Ry times seismic forces plus 1.1 times factored gravity load
combinations. Column shear forces are not a controlling factor and are not shown
for the sake of brevity.
Level
Section
A
(in.2)
Zx
(in.3)
Sx
(in.3)
L
(ft)
rx
(in.)
(in.)
5
4
3
2
1
W12X87
W12X87
W12X87
W12X170
W12X170
26
26
26
50
50
132
132
132
275
275
118
118
118
235
235
18
18
18
18
19
5.38
5.38
5.38
5.74
5.74
3.07
3.07
3.07
3.22
3.22
kl r y
71.4
71.4
71.4
67.4
71.3
Fy
(ksi)
50
50
50
50
50
Section
R
5
4
3
2
W12X87
W12X87
W12X87
W12X170
W12X170
PE
ME
Overstr.
Factor
0
84
238
458
683
276
432
504
552
972
1.15
1.22
1.25
1.27
1.33
1.10
1.10
1.10
1.10
1.10
Pgravity
M gravity
1.465D+
0.5L
1.465D+
0.5L
4.0
22.0
44.0
67.0
87.0
168.0
180.0
144.0
120.0
60.0
Overstr.
Factor
Ry
Pbu
design
1.10
1.10
1.10
1.10
1.10
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
4
170
473
906
1,395
M bu
design
638
949
1,057
1,136
1,915
Section
Lu
(ft)
kl r y
Fcr
(ksi)
Pn
(kips)
R
5
4
3
2
W12X87
W12X87
W12X87
W12X170
W12X170
12
12
12
12
15
46.9
46.9
46.9
44.8
56.0
0.620
0.620
0.620
0.592
0.740
42.56
42.56
42.56
43.18
39.76
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
0.85
1,089.6
1,089.6
1,089.6
2,159.0
1,988.1
135
Design Example 2
b
(ksi)
Mn = M p
(k-in.)
Cb
(kips)
Lb
(in.)
(in.)
R
5
4
3
2
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
6,600.0
6,600.0
6,600.0
13,750.0
13,750.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
144
144
144
144
180
130
130
130
136
136
Lp
X1
X2
FL
(k-in.)
Lr
Mr
(k-in.)
Mn
(k-in.)
3,869
3,869
3,869
7,173
7,173
0.0006
0.0006
0.0006
0.0001
0.0001
40
40
40
40
40
459
459
459
824
824
4,720 6,521.0
4,720 6,521.0
4,720 6,521.0
9,400 13,702.1
9,400 13,474.4
Mn
(k-in.)
6,521
6,521
6,521
13,702
13,474
6p.
Level
Section
Pu
Pn
AISC
LRFD
H1-1a
AISC
LRFD
H1-1b
5
4
3
2
1
W12X87
W12X87
W12X87
W12X170
W12X170
0.00
0.18
0.51
0.49
0.83
NA
NA
0.67
0.58
0.97
0.11
0.25
NA
NA
NA
Beams
Links (in.)
Roof
5
4
3
2
1
W14x38
W16x89
W21x111
W21x122
W27x178
32
48
56
56
66
6x
6x
6x
6x
Not reqd
Columns
Braces
W12X65
W12X65
W12X65
W12X87
W12X87
W12X87
W12X87
W12X87
W12X106
W12X120
Note:
1. Top and bottom flanges outside link.
136
Design Example 2
7.
Figures 2-7 through 2-14 are examples of typical EBF connection details. These
are shown for both wide-flange and tube section braces.
Figure 2-7. EBF brace-beam connection at link using wide flange brace
137
Design Example 2
138
Design Example 2
139
Design Example 2
140
Design Example 2
Figure 2-14. Link beam cover plates (beam outside the link)
Commentary
EBF frames are considered a quality seismic system because of their ability to
yield with a known behavior at controllable locations and to demonstrate very good
hysteretic behavior during cyclical loading. The possibility exists of discrete
postearthquake repairs in local areas if yielding of a frame occurs in an earthquake.
The construction of these frames is not difficult, and the cost is only slightly
greater than the cost of special concentric braced frame systems.
As can be seen, the LRFD design in accordance with AISC-Seismic yields more
conservative results. However, the provisions of AISC-Seismic are considered
state-of-the-art and more likely to yield an EBF frame with the superior
performance that is expected of EBF systems.
It was found that by designing an EBF link beam that meets all of the most
desirable attributes of EBF design, that the beam outside the link might require
cover plates to achieve the required strength. The designer will struggle with
optimization of the link design and the requirement for cover plates outside the
link. It is believed that optimization of the link is the most important element in the
system and if cover plates are required outside the link, that is a cost worth paying.
In the ASD example, the link lengths (to 1.3Vs/Ms), were not optimized and thus
did not need cover plates. However, from a performance standpoint, the ASD
frame may not be as good a design as the LRFD frame because its link lengths are
much shorter.
141
Design Example 2
References
Becker and Ishler, Seismic Design Practice for Eccentrically Braced Frames, Based
on the 1994 UBC, Steel Tips. Structural Steel Educational Council, Moraga,
California, December 1996.
Popov, Kasai, and Engelhardt, 1987. Advances in Design of Eccentrically Braced
Frames, Earthquake Spectra. Earthquake Engineering Research Institute,
Oakland, California, Vol.3, no.1.
Engelhardt and Popov, 1989. On Design of Eccentrically Braced Frames,
Earthquake Spectra. Earthquake Engineering Research Institute, Oakland,
California, Vol. 5, No. 3.
Popov, Engelhardt, and Ricles, 1989. Eccentrically Braced Frames: US Practice,
Engineering Journal. American Society of Civil Engineers, Reston, Virginia,
AISC, 2nd quarter.
Kasai and Popov, 1986. General Behavior of WF Steel Shear Link Beams, Journal
of Structural Engineering. American Society of Civil Engineers, Reston,
Virginia, Vol. 112, no. 2.
142
Design Example 3A
Design Example 3A
Steel Special Moment Resisting Frame
Figure 3A-1. Four-story steel office building with steel special moment resisting frames (SMRF)
Foreword
This Design Example illustrates use of the 1997 UBC provisions for design of a
steel special moment resisting frame (SMRF). During the course of the
development of this Volume III, an intensive steel moment frame research
program, including considerable full-scale testing, was conducted by the SAC
project. As a result of this effort, new SAC guidelines have been developed.
However, these came after the finalization of this Design Example. Consequently,
the SMRF example given in this document shows only 1997 UBC and
FEMA-267/267A methodology. With the help of member of the SAC team,
comments have been added to this Design Example indicating where the
anticipated new SAC guidelines will be different than the methodology shown in
this Design Example.
143
Design Example 3A
Overview
Since the 1994 Northridge earthquake, the prior design procedures for steel
moment resisting frames have been subject to criticism, re-evaluation, and
intensive reseach. Given the observed earthquake damage attributed to brittle
connection fractures in the 1994 Northridge earthquake, it was determined that the
1994 UBC requirements for moment resisting joint design were inadequate and
should not continue to be used in new construction. In September 1994, the
International Conference of Building Officials (ICBO) issued an emergency code
amendment that eliminated the prescriptive code design procedures for special
moment resisting frame (SMRF) beam-column connections. Those procedures
were replaced with code language requiring qualification of SMRF connection
design through prototype testing or calculation. A SMRF conection is now
required to demonstrate by testing or calculation the capacity to meet both the
strength and inelastic rotation performance as specified by 1997 UBC 2213.7.1.
To address the research needs precipitated by the SMRF connection concerns, the
SAC Joint Venture was formed by SEAOC, the Applied Technology Council
(ATC), and the California Universities for Research in Earthquake Engneering
(CUREe). SAC was charged with developing interim recommendations for
professional practice, including design guidelines for use in new SMRF
connections. To this end, FEMA-267, Interim Guidelines: Evaluation, Repair,
Modification and Design of Welded Steel Moment Frame Structures was published
in August, 1995. This was followed by FEMA-267A, Interim Guidelines; Advisory
No. 1, published in March, 1997.
As a prelude to possible future code requirements, FEMA-267A offers design
procedures and calculation methodologies for certain SMRF connection
configurations. While these procedures are subject to further refinement, they
represent the current state of practice for SMRF connection design. This Design
Example follows the procedures as presented in FEMA-267A, with the reduced
beam section (RBS) the selected joint configuration. Test results for the RBS joint
configuration indicate that it provides the requisite inelastic rotation capacity, and
is one of the more cost-effective of the current SMRF connection options.
Following publication of the FEMA-267 series, the SAC Joint Venture entered into
a supplemental contract with FEMA to perform additional research and develop
final design guidelines. That work, recently completed, culminated with the
publication of FEMA-350, Recommended Seismic Design Criteria for New
Moment Resisting Steel Frame Structures. FEMA-350 will present design details
and criteria for ten different types of connections that are prequalified for use
within certain limits. The FEMA-350 criteria are similar, but not identical, to those
illustrated here.
144
Design Example 3A
The 4-story steel office structure shown in Figure 3A-1 is to have special moment
resisting frames as its lateral force resisting system. The typical floor plan is shown
on Figure 3A-2 and the moment frame elevation is provided in Figure 3A-3 at the
end of this Design Example.
Outline
This Design Example illustrates the following parts of the design process.
1.
2.
3.
Interstory drifts.
4.
5.
6.
Given Information
The following information is given:
Roof weights:
Roofing
Insulation
Concrete fill on metal deck
Ceiling
Mechanical/electrical
Steel framing
Total
4.0 psf
2.0
44.0
3.0
4.0
6.0
63.0 psf
Floor weights:
Floor covering
Concrete fill on metal deck
Ceiling
Mechanical/electrical
Steel framing
Partitions (seismic DL)
Total
1.0 psf
44.0
3.0
5.0
9.0
10.0
76.0 psf
Live load:
20.0 psf
Live load:
80.0 psf
20.0 psf
145
Design Example 3A
Structural materials:
Wide flange shapes
Plates
Weld electrodes
1629.2
Table 16-K
1629.3, Table 16-J
1629.4.1, Table 16-I
1629.4.2
10 km
Table 16-S
N a = 1.0
N v = 1.0
Table 16-T
Table 16-U
146
Design Example 3A
1.
1a.
Code Reference
1629.5
Table 16-L
Table 16-M
The floor plan has no re-entrant corners exceeding 15 percent of the plan
dimension, nor are there any diaphragm discontinuities. Therefore, the structure
has no plan irregularities.
147
Design Example 3A
1b.
1629.6
Table 16-N
= 2.8
hmax = no limit
1c.
1629.8.3
The static lateral force procedure will be used. This is permitted for regular
structures not more than 240 feet in height.
1d.
1629.4.3
1e.
Table 16-Q
Table 16-R
1630.2.2
Per Method A:
(30-8)
T = Ct (hn )3 4
C t = 0.035
T A = 0.03(55.5)3 4 = 0.71 sec
Per Method B:
Using a computer model, in lieu of Eq. (30-10), with assumed member sizes and
estimated building weights, the period is determined:
148
Design Example 3A
North-south ( y ) :
TBy = 1.30 sec
East-west (x ):
1630.2.2
Para. #2
1f.
1630.2.1
Cv I
0.64(1.0 )
W =
W = 0.082W
RT
8.5(0.92 )
(30-4)
2.5Ca I
2.5(0.44 )(1.0 )
W =
= 0.129W
R
8.5
(30-5)
(30-6)
0.8ZN v I
0.8(0.4)(1.0)(1.0)
W =
= 0.038W
R
8.5
(30-7)
(30-4)
149
Design Example 3A
Note that if the period from Method A (T = 0.71sec) was used, the base shear
would be V = 0.106W . Method A is based on empirical relationships and is not
considered as accurate as Method B. To avoid unconservative use of Method B,
the code limits the period for Method B to not more than 1.3 times the Method A
period.
1g.
1630.1
Section 1630.1.1 specifies earthquake loads. These are E and E m as set forth in
Equations (30-1) and (30-2).
E = E h + E v
(30-1)
Em = o Eh
(30-2)
The normal earthquake design load is E . The load E m is the estimated maximum
earthquake force that can be developed in the structure. It is used only when
specifically required, as will be shown later in this Design Example.
Before determining the earthquake forces for design, the reliability/redundancy
factor must be determined.
Reliability/redundancy factor: = 2
20
(30-3)
rmax Ab
Ab is the ground floor area of the structure. Note that per the exception in
1630.1, Ab may be taken as the average floor area in the upper setback portion in
buildings with a larger ground floor area and a smaller upper floor area.
Ab = (140 240) 8(8.5)2 / 2 = 33,311 ft 2
The element story shear ratio ri is the ratio of the story shear in the most heavily
loaded single element over the total story shear at a given level i . The value for
rmax is the greatest value for ri occurring in any story in the lower two-thirds of
the structure. In structures with setbacks or discontinuous frames, the value of ri
should be checked at each level. For this Design Example, the frames are uniform
at all levels and will resist approximately the same relative lateral force at each
story. For moment frames, ri is taken as the maximum of the sum of the shears in
any two adjacent columns in a moment frame bay, divided by the story shear. The
exception is that for interior columns in multi-bay frames, 70 percent of the shear
may be used in the column shear summation.
150
Design Example 3A
By observation, the moment frame with the highest total shear per bay will govern
the value for rmax . For this Design Example, the design base shear is equal for both
north-south and east-west directions. Referring to the floor framing plan
(Figure 3A-2), the east-west direction has 16 moment frame columns, while the
north-south direction has 12 moment frame columns; so the north-south rmax will
be greatest. Although a different value of may be used for each direction, the
larger rmax will be used for both directions in this Design Example to be
conservative.
Assume that the frames at Lines A and H each take half the story shear. Using the
portal method for the frame at Line A (Figure 3A-4), the four interior columns take
approximately 80 percent of the frame shear, and the two exterior columns
20 percent of the frame shear.
F=50%
0.05V
0.1V
0.1V
0.1V
0.1V
0.05V
20
0.147(33,311)1 / 2
= 1.25
o.k.
(30-3)
Note that cannot be less than 1.0, and that for SMRFs, cannot exceed 1.25
per 1630.1.1. If necessary, moment frame bays must be added until this
requirement is met.
151
Design Example 3A
For the load combinations per 1612, and anticipating using allowable stress
design (ASD) in the frame design:
E = E h + E v = 1.25(V ) ( E v = 0 for allowable stress design)
(30-1)
E m = E h = 2.8(V )
(30-2)
Note that seismic forces may be assumed to act nonconcurrently in each principal
direction of the structure, except as per 1633.1. Although for this Design Example
the same value of is used in either direction, a different value of may be used
for each of the principal directions.
2.
2a.
Calculate the building weight and center of gravity at each level. Include an
additional 90 kips (3.0 psf) at the roof level for estimated weight of mechanical
equipment. Distribute the exterior curtain wall to each level by tributary height.
152
Design Example 3A
Roof: w DL = 63.0 + 3.0add'lmech = 66.0 psf ; Exterior Walls: w wall = 20 psf ; Wall Area = (6.5 + 4.0)(696 ft ) = 7,308 ft 2
Mark
Floor
Walls
Totals
w DL
(psf)
66.0
20.0
Wi
(kips)
1,920
146
2,066
Area
(sf)
29,090
7,308
X cg
Ycg
(ft)
100
100
(ft)
70
70
( )
( )
W X cg
W Ycg
191,994
14,616
206,610
134,396
10,231
144,627
Floor: w DL = 72.0 psf ; Exterior Walls: w wall = 15 psf ; Wall Area = (13.5)(696 ft ) = 9,396 ft 2
Mark
Floor
Walls
Totals
w DL
(psf)
72.0
15.0
Wi
(kips)
2,094
141
2,235
Area
(sf)
29,090
9,396
X cg
Ycg
(ft)
100
100
(ft)
70
70
( )
( )
W X cg
W Ycg
209,448
14,094
223,542
146,614
9,866
156,479
W
(kips)
X cg
Ycg
(ft)
(ft)
Roof
2,066
100
70
(1)
M (2)
MMI (3)
5.3
26,556
4th
2,235
100
70
5.8
28,728
3rd
2,235
100
70
5.8
28,728
2nd
2,235
100
70
5.8
28,728
Total
8,771
22.7
Notes:
1. Mass (M) and mass moment of inertia (MMI) are used in analysis for determination of
fundamental period (T).
2. M = (W/386.4) (kips-sec2/in.)
3. MMI = M/A (lx + ly) (kips-sec2-in.)
153
Design Example 3A
2b.
2c.
1630.5
For the static lateral force procedure, vertical distribution of force to each level is
applied as follows:
V = Ft + Fi where Ft = 0.07T (V ) 0.25(V )
(30-13)
(30-14)
(V Ft )Wx hx = (673.6 )
W x hx
Wi hi
Wi hi
(30-15)
wx
(kips)
hx
(ft)
w x hx
(k-ft)
w x hx
wx
Fx
(kips)
Roof
2,066
55.5
114,663
0.375
299.0
4th
2,235
42.0
93,870
0.307
206.8
V
(kips)
299.0
3rd
2,235
28.5
63,698
0.208
140.3
505.8
2nd
2,235
15.0
33,525
0.110
73.9
646.1
Total
8,771
305,756
1.000
720.0
720.0
154
Design Example 3A
2d.
1630.6
Structures with concrete fill floor decks are typically assumed to have rigid
diaphragms. Seismic forces are distributed to the moment frames according to their
relative rigidities. For structures with assumed rigid diaphragms, an accidental
torsion must be applied (in addition to any actual torsional moment) equal to that
caused by displacing the center of mass 5 percent of the building dimension
perpendicular to the direction of the applied lateral force.
For the structural computer model of this Design Example, this can be achieved by
combining the direct seismic force applied at the center of mass at each level with
a torsional moment at each level:
North-south:
M t = 0.05(204 ft )FX = (10.2 )FX
East-west:
M t = 0.05(144 ft )FX = (7.2)FX
Fx
(kips)
N/S M t
(k-ft)
E/W M t
(k-ft)
Roof
299.0
3,050
2,153
4th
206.8
2,109
1,489
3rd
140.3
1,431
1,010
2nd
73.9
754
532
Using the direct seismic forces and torsional moments noted above, the force distribution to the
frames is generated by computer analysis. The torsional seismic component is always additive to
the direct seismic force. For the computer model, member sizes are initially proportioned by
extrapolation from the tested configurations for SMRF reduced beam section joints, as discussed
in Part 6 below.
From the preliminary computer analysis, the shear force at the ground level is determined for each
frame column. As shown in Figure 3A-5, there are a total of six rigid frames: A1, A2, B1, B2, B3,
and B4. Frames A1 and A2 are identical. Frames B1, B2, B3, and B4 are also identical.
Recognizing that the building is symmetrical, the frame forces are the same for Frames A1 and
A2, as well as for Frames B1 through B4. Frame forces at the base of each frame type, A1 and B1
are summarized in Tables 3A-5 and 3A-6.
155
Design Example 3A
Line A/1.2
(kips)
Line A/2
(kips)
Line A/3
(kips)
Line A/4
(kips)
Line A/5
(kips)
Line A/5.8
(kips)
Total
(kips)
Direct Seismic
41.8
75.2
69.7
69.7
75.2
41.8
373.4
Torsion Force
2.6
4.6
4.3
4.3
4.6
2.6
23.0
Direct + Torsion
44.4
79.8
74.0
74.0
79.8
44.4
396.4
Line 1/B
(kips)
Line 1/C
(kips)
Line 1/C.8
(kips)
Total
(kips)
Line 1/A.2
(kips)
Direct Seismic
33.4
59.9
59.9
33.4
186.6
Torsion Force
1.3
2.3
2.3
1.3
7.2
Direct + Torsion
34.7
62.2
62.2
34.7
193.8
As a check on the computer output, compare the total column shears with the
direct seismic base shear of 720 kips:
North-south:
Ftype A = 2(373.4 ) = 746.8 > 720 kips
o.k.
East-west:
Ftype B = 4(186.6 ) = 746.4 > 720 kips
o.k.
The summation of the column shears is about 3 percent greater than the design
base shear input to the computer model. This is mostly due to the inclusion of P
effects in the computer analysis. As required by 1630.1.3, P effects are to be
considered when the ratio of secondary (i.e., moment due to P effects) to
primary moments exceeds 10 percent.
Next, to refine the initial approximation for rmax and , the actual column shears
for Frame A1 from Table 3A-5 above will be used.
rmax = 0.7(79.8 + 74.0 ) / 747 = 0.144
=2
156
20
0.144(33,311)1 / 2
= 1.24 1.25
o.k.
Design Example 3A
3.
3a.
Interstory drift.
Determine S and M.
The design level response displacement S is the story displacement at the center
of mass. It is obtained from a static-elastic analysis using the design seismic forces
derived above. For purposes of displacement determination, however, 1630.10.3
eliminates the upper limit on TB , used to determine base shear under Equation
(30-4). The maximum inelastic response displacement M includes both elastic
and estimated inelastic drifts resulting from the design basis ground motion. It is
computed as follows:
M = 0.7(R ) S = 0.7(8.5) S = 5.95 S
(30-17)
The maximum values for S and M are determined, including torsional effects
(and including P effects for M ). Without the 1.3T A limit on TB , the design
base shear per Equation (30-4) is:
North-south:
TBy = 1.30 sec
Vn / s =
Cv I
0.64(1.0 )
W =
W = 0.058W = 509 kips
8.5(1.30)
RT
(30-4)
East-west:
TBx = 1.16 sec
Ve / w =
Cv I
0.64(1.0 )
W =
W = 0.064W = 561 kips
8.5(1.16 )
RT
Note that 1630.9.1 and 1630.1.1 require use of the unfactored base shear V, with
= 1 . Using these modified design base shears, the accidental torsion and force
distribution to each level are adjusted for input to the computer model. The
structure displacements and drift ratios are derived as shown below in Table 3A-7.
157
Design Example 3A
Height
h (in.)
S Drift
(in.)
M Drift
(in.)
Drift Ratio
( M h )
4th
3rd
2nd
1st
162
162
162
180
1.19
1.84
2.26
2.80
0.0073
0.0114
0.0140
0.0156
Height
h (in.)
S Drift
(in.)
M Drift
(in.)
Drift Ratio
( M h )
4th
3rd
2nd
1st
162
162
162
180
0.95
1.61
1.96
2.38
0.0059
0.0099
0.0121
0.0132
3b.
1630.10
For structures with T > 0.7 , the allowable story drift is: M = 0.020 (story
height). A review of drift ratios tabulated in Table 3A-7 shows that all interstory
drift ratios are less than 0.020, using seismic forces corresponding to the actual
period TB in base shear Equation (30-4). Also, note that all drift ratios are less
than (0.95)(0.020 ) = 0.019 . This 5 percent reduction in the drift limit is required
for reduced beam section joint designs under FEMA-267A.
Looking ahead to the SMRF member design, 2213.7.10 imposes certain
conditions on moment frame drift calculations, including bending and shear
contributions from clear beam-column spans, column axial deformation, and panel
zone distortion. These conditions are met by most general purpose structural
analysis programs used in building design, except for the contribution to frame
drift from panel zone distortion. The code provides an exception whereby a
centerline analysis may be used if the column panel zone strength can develop
80 percent (0.8M s ) of the strength of the girders framing into the joint. As will
be seen from the SMRF beam-column joint design, this condition will always be
met under the current performance criteria. Moreover, the FEMA-267A provisions
produce stronger, stiffer column panel zone designs than previously permitted by
the UBC. Therefore, panel zone distortion will generally not contribute
significantly to overall frame drift.
158
Design Example 3A
To gain a feel for the influence of beam-column joint stiffness on overall frame
drift, two conditions are modeled for east-west seismic forces, with the lateral
displacements at the roof derived as follows:
Centerline analysis: 1.37 inches
50 percent rigid joint analysis: 1.17 inches
The centerline analysis produces a displacement 17 percent greater than the
50 percent rigid joint analysis. Most engineers feel that the centerline analysis
over-estimates, and the 100 percent rigid joint underestimates, the actual frame
drift. The 50 percent rigid joint analysis is an accepted standard of practice for
providing reasonable design solutions for frame displacements.
4.
4a.
1633.2.9
Ft + Fi
wi
(w px )
(33-1)
The diaphragm forces at each level, with the upper and lower limits, are calculated
as shown in Table 3A-8 below. Note that the 0.5C a IW px minimum controls for
this building.
Fi (1)
(kips)
Fi
(kips)
wx
(kips) (1)
w i
(kips)
FPx
(kips) (2)
0.5Ca Iw Px
(kips) (3)
1.0Ca Iw Px
(kips) (3)
Roof
4th
3rd
2nd
299.0
206.8
140.3
73.9
299.0
505.8
646.1
720.0
2,066
2,235
2,235
2,235
2,066
4,301
6,536
8,771
299.0
262.8
220.9
183.5
454.5
491.7
491.7
491.7
909.0
983.4
983.4
983.4
Notes:
1. See Table 3A-3.
2. Ft = 46.4 kips (see Part 2c)
3. Ca = 0.44 kips (see Part 1d)
159
Design Example 3A
4b.
and the 491.7 kip force at the floor levels is used for design. This value is not
factored up by per 1630.1.1. The reliability/redundancy factor is only
applied to transfer diaphragms (see Blue Book 105.1.1).
E floor = FP = 491.7 kips
(30-1)
The maximum diaphragm span occurs between Lines A and H, so the north-south
direction will control.
Although the computer model assumes rigid diaphragms for load distribution to
the frames, we now consider the diaphragm as a horizontal beam. Shears at each
line of resistance are derived assuming the diaphragm spans as simple beams under
a uniform load.
160
Design Example 3A
Using the alternate basic load combination of Equation (12-13) for allowable stress
design, the factored diaphragm design shear at Line A is (E/1.4):
qA =
(V ) =
1.4
246
= 1.25 k-ft
1.4(140')
Using 3-inch light weight concrete over 3" 20 gauge deck, with 4 welds per
sheet at end laps and button punch at 12 in. side laps, the allowable deck shear per
the manufacturers ICBO Evaluation Report is:
Vallow = 1.75 > 1.25 k-ft
4c.
o.k.
Assuming the diaphragm acts as a simple beam between Lines A and H (and this is
the usual assumption), the maximum chord force at Lines 1.2 and 5.8 for northsouth seismic is:
CF =
2.46(200)2
= 100.0 k
8(123)
Because the beam framing is continuous on Lines 1.2 and 5.8, these lines are
chosen to resist the chord force. [Lines 1 and 6 have indentations in the floor plan
(Figure 3A-2).] The chord force must be compared to the collector force at these
lines, and the greatest value used for design.
For east-west seismic loads, the factored shear flow at Line 1.2 is approximately:
q1.2 =
491.7
= 1.23 k-ft
(2)(200')
Figure 3A-7 shows the collector force diaphragm for Line 1.2.
161
Design Example 3A
(30-2)
The seismic drag tie or chord can be implemented using supplemental slab
reinforcing. With the strength design method for concrete per 1612, including
Exception 2, the factored collector and chord forces are:
Factored chord force: Tu = 1.1(E ) = 1.1(100.0 ) = 110.0 kips
1612.4
(12-17)
The factored chord forces for north-south seismic loads govern the design at
Line 1.2. The required slab chord reinforcing is calculated as:
Required As = Tu f y = 110.0 0.9(60) = 2.0 in.2
Use 4-#7, As = 2.4 in.2
5.
In this Part, representative beam and column members of Frame A1 are designed
under the provisions of 2213.7. Certain provisions of 2213.7 pertaining to joint
design have been modified by the recommendations of FEMA-267A. These
provisions, including the strong column-weak beam and panel zone requirements,
are discussed with the RBS joint design in Part 6 of this Design Example.
From past experience, steel moment frame designs have typically been drift
controlled. Frame members were chosen with sufficient stiffness to meet the drift
limits, and then checked for the SMRF design requirements. However, to meet the
intent of 2213.7.1, the design process begins by selecting beam-column
combinations extrapolated from tested RBS joint assemblies. The rationale for
selection of the member sizes is also presented in Part 6, with a W 30 108 beam
and W 14 283 column chosen for this Design Example.
162
Design Example 3A
5a.
rd
The typical beam selected to illustrate beam design is a third-floor beam in Frame
A1. This is shown in Figure 3A-8 below.
From a review of the computer output prepared separately for this Design
Example, the moments and shears at the right end of the beam are greatest. The
moments and shears at the face of the column at Line 5 are:
M DL = 1,042 kip-in.
M LL = 924 kip-in.
M seis = 3,590 kip-in.
M E = M seis = 1.25(3,590 ) = 4,487 kip-in.
V DL = 16.4 kips
V LL = 13.3 kips
Vseis = 22.3 kips
VE = Vseis = 1.25(22.3) = 27.9 kips
1630.1.1
163
Design Example 3A
The basic load combinations of 1612.3.1 (ASD) are used, with no one-third
increase. (These were selected to illustrate their usage, although generally it is
more advantageous to use the alternate basic load combinations of 1612.3.2.)
D + L : M D +L = 1,042 + 924 = 1,966 kip-in.
(12-8)
E
4,487
: M D +E = 1,042 +
= 4,247 kip-in.
1.4
1.4
VD + E = 16.4 +
(12-9)
27.9
= 36.3 kips
1.4
E
4,487
D + 0.75 L +
: M D + L + E = 1,042 + 0.75924 +
= 4,139 kip-in.
1.4
1.4
(12-11)
27.9
VD + L + E = 16.4 + 0.7513.3 +
= 41.3 kips
1.4
52
50
= 7.35
For W 30 108 :
and
bf
2t f
and
d
640
= 90.5
tw
50
d 29.83
=
= 54.7 < 90.5
t w 0.545
o.k.
o.k.
164
Design Example 3A
( )
o.k.
( )
Fv = 0.4 F y
h 29.83 2(0.76 )
380
=
= 51.9 <
= 53.7
tw
0.545
50
= 0.4(50 ) = 20.0 ksi
o.k.
5b.
nd
story.
165
Design Example 3A
V E = 1.25(56.8) = 71 kips
PDL = 113 kips
PLL = 75 kips
Pseis = 28 kips
PE = 1.25(28) = 35 kips
The maximum strong axis moments occur at the bottom of the column, and are
taken at the top flange of the second-floor beam.
(12-8)
166
Design Example 3A
D+
4,963
E
: M D + E = 236 +
= 3,781 kip-in.
1.4
1.4
(12-9)
35
= 138 kips
1.4
71.0
= 3.1 +
= 53.8 kips
1.4
PD + E = 113 +
VD + E
0.9 D
E
35
: PD E = 0.9(113)
= 76.7 kips compression
1.4
1.4
4,963
E
D + 0.75 L +
= 3,046 kip-in.
: M D + L + E = 236 + 0.75201 +
1.4
1.4
(12-10)
(12-11)
71.0
= 43 kips
VD + L + E = 3.1 + 0.75 2.7 +
1.4
35
PD + L + E = 113 + 0.75 75 +
= 188 kips
1.4
Under the requirements of 2213.5.1, columns must have the strength to resist the
following axial load combinations (neglecting flexure):
PDL + 0.7 PLL + Pseis : Pcomp = 113 + 0.7(75) + 2.8(28) = 244 kips compression
0.85PDL Pseis :
The intent of these supplemental load combinations is to ensure that the columns
have adequate axial strength to preclude buckling when subjected to the maximum
seismic force that can be developed in the structure.
Try W 14 283 , ASTM A572, Grade 50 column.
Unbraced column height (taken from top of framing at bottom to mid-depth of
beam at top):
h = 13.5 (2.5 2 ) = 12.25 ft
167
Design Example 3A
Under 2213.5.3, the factor k can be taken as unity if the column is continuous,
drift ratios are met per 1630.8, and f a 0.4 F y . The example column is
( )
f a 2.26
=
= 0.085 < 0.15
Fa 26.5
( )
f
f
E
138
3,781
: a + bx =
+
= 0.063 + 0.250 = 0.313 < 1.0 o.k.
1.4 Fa Fb
83.3(26.5) 459(33.0 )
3,046
E f a f bx
+
= 0.085 +
= 0.286 < 1.0
D + 0.75 L +
:
459(33.0 )
1.4 Fa Fb
o.k.
(12-9)
(12-11)
168
o.k.
Design Example 3A
o.k.
Tension:
Pst = F y A = 50(83.3) = 4,165 kips
o.k.
For W 14 283 :
bf
2t f
o.k.
6.
As discussed in FEMA-267 (Sections 7.3 and 7.5), SMRF joint designs may be
acceptable without testing of a particular beam-column combination only with the
following qualifications:
1. Joint design calculations are based on comparisons with tested assemblies.
2. The joint configuration considered closely mirror the tested detail.
3. Calculated member sizes are extrapolated from tested combinations.
4. A qualified third party peer review is performed.
169
Design Example 3A
This Design Example utilizes tests conducted at the University of Texas Ferguson
Laboratory [Engelhardt et al., 1996]. Testing of additional RBS joint combinations
was performed as part of the SAC Phase II program. Results of these tests will be
published by SAC when available; updates may be found at SACs web site:
http://quiver.eerc.berkeley.edu:8080/design/conndbase/index.html.
Using the circular cut reduced beam section, the following beam-column joint
assemblies were successfully tested at the University of Texas:
Column
Beam
DB2
DB3
DB4
DB5
W14x426
W14x426
W14x426
W14x257
W36x150
W36x170
W36x194
W30x148
Each of these specimens achieved plastic chord rotation capacity exceeding 0.03
radians, the recommended acceptance criterion per FEMA-267A (Section 7.2.4).
The parameters for extrapolation or interpolation of beam-column test results are
difficult to determine. When extrapolating, it should be done only with a basic
understanding of the behavior of the tested assembly. The California Division of
the State Architect (DSA), in the commentary to its Interpretation of Regulations
27-8 (DSA IR 27-8), has established guidelines for extrapolation of joint tests.
Until further testing is completed, DSA recommends that members sizes taken
from tested configurations be extrapolated, by weight or flange thickness, no more
than 15 percent upward or no more than 35 percent downward.
Using the DSA criteria for extrapolation with the lightest column section (DB5) of
the tested sizes noted above, the following possible beam-column size
combinations are possible:
W 14 257 column:
Max. weight = 296 lbs.
170
Design Example 3A
W 30 148 beam:
Max. weight = 170 lbs.
Min. weight = 96 lbs.
6a.
When determining the strength of a frame element, FEMA 7.2.2 defaults back to
2213.4.2. Material strength properties are stipulated in FEMA 7.5.1,
Table 7.5.1-1. FEMA-267A modified the allowable through-thickness stress to 0.9
(Fy) in recognition of improved joint performance for configurations locating the
plastic hinge away from the face of the column. For this Design Example, material
strengths are taken as:
171
Design Example 3A
6b.
The fundamental design intent espoused in FEMA-267 is to move the plastic hinge
away from the column face. The RBS design achieves that goal in providing a
well-defined, relatively predictable plastic hinge region. Of the various RBS
options, the circular curved configuration is chosen due to its combination of tested
performance and economy of fabrication.
The distance c from the face of the column (see Figure 3A-10) to the beginning of
the circular cut, and the length of the cut l c , are based on prior RBS tests. It is
desirable to minimize c to reduce the amplification of M f at the face of the
column.
FEMA-267A recommends that c = d b / 4 , while Englehardt [1998] recommends
0.5b f c 0.75b f . As the member sizes for this Design Example are
extrapolated from testing by Englehardt, c 0.6b f is selected. Both FEMA-267A
and Englehardt recommend l c 0.75d .
172
Design Example 3A
W 30 108 :
0.5b f = 0.5(10.5) = 5.25 in.
0.75b f = 0.75(10.5) = 7.88 in.
Use c = 6.0 in.
lc = 0.75d = 0.75(29.83) = 22.37 in.
Use lc = 24.0 in.
The depth of the cut n should be made such that 40 percent to 50 percent of the
flange is removed. This will limit the projection of moments at the face of the
column to within 90 percent to 100 percent of the plastic capacity of the full beam
section. With a 45 percent reduction in the flange area:
bf
n = 0.45
2
0.45(10.5)
=
= 2.36 in.
2
173
Design Example 3A
and:
L = 28.0 ft.
L' = 28 2(26.37 / 12 ) = 23.6 ft
The length between the plastic hinges L ' (see Figure 3A-11) is used to determine
forces at the critical sections for joint analysis.
The circular curved cut provides for a gradual transition in beam flange area. This
configuration also satisfies the intent of 2213.7.9.
6c.
Determine probable plastic moment and shear at the reduced beam section.
The plastic section modulus at the center of the reduced beam section is calculated
per FEMA 7.5.3.2 as:
[ (
Z RBS = Z x br t f d t f
)]
where b r is the total width of material cut from the beam flange.
br = 2(2.25) = 4.5 in. and
Z RBS = 346 [4.5(0.76 )(29.83 0.76)] = 247 in.3
174
Design Example 3A
Next, the probable plastic moment at the reduced beam section Mpr is calculated as:
M pr = Z RBS (FY )
The factor accounts for both variations in the beam steel average yield stress
and strain hardening at the plastic hinge. Per FEMA 7.5.2.2, for ASTM A572
steel, = 1 .2 . Therefore:
M pr = 247(1.2)(50 ) = 14,820 kip-in.
As illustrated in FEMA 7.5.2.3, the shear at the plastic hinge is derived by statics,
considering both the plastic moment at the hinge and gravity loads. For simplicity,
the beam shear from the frame analysis for dead and live loads at the hinge is used.
To be consistent with this strength design procedure, the special seismic load
combinations of 1612.4 are used:
Mpr
Mpr
VE
VE
VE =
2 M pr
L'
2(14,820 )
= 104.7 kips
12(23.6)
and:
V P = 1.2(V D ) + 0.5(V L ) + 1.0(V E )
V P = 1.2(16.4 ) + 0.5(13.3) + 1.0(104.7 ) = 131 kips
6d.
There are two critical sections for the joint evaluation. The first section is at the
interface of the beam section and the face of the column flange. The strength
demand at this section is used to check the capacity of the beam flange weld to the
column, the through-thickness stress on the column flange (at the area joined to the
beam flange), and the column panel zone shear strength. The second critical
section occurs at the column centerline. The moment demand at this location is
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
175
Design Example 3A
used to check the strong column-weak beam requirement per FEMA 7.5.2.5
(UBC 2213.7.5).
a. Column face
b. Column centerline
FEMA 7.5.2.4
6e.
Section 7.5.3.2 of FEMA-267A lists four criteria for the evaluation of RBS joint
capacity:
1. At the reduced section, the beam must have the capacity to meet all code
required forces (i.e. dead, live & seismic per 1612).
176
2.
Code required drift limits must be met considering effects of the RBS.
3.
4.
The through-thickness stress on the face of the column at the beam flange
must be within the allowable values listed in FEMA 7.5.1. (Note: In
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
Design Example 3A
14.92
As discussed in FEMA 7.5.3, the RBS will reduce overall frame stiffness
approximately 5 percent, thereby increasing calculated frame displacements about
5 percent proportionally. To account for this increase, the allowable drift limits are
reduced 5 percent for comparison to calculated frame lateral deflections from the
computer analysis. As shown in Part 3b, the structure drift ratios are found to be
within the reduced code limits.
Check beam-to-column welded connection.
The W 30 108 beam and W 14 283 column are extrapolated from specimen sizes
tested in an RBS configuration at the University of Texas. In the tested
configuration, the beam webs have complete-penetration welds to the column
flange. Under FEMA 7.8.2, the web connection should be consistent with the
tested assembliesthis weld is shown in Figure 3A-17.
Note: In FEMA-350, RBS and other connections have been prequalified for
application within ranges of member and frame sizes. As long as framing falls
within prequalified limits, reference to specific test data is not required.
Using the cross-sectional area of the beam flange and web weldments at the face of
the column (Figure 3A-14), the elastic section modulus S c of the beam is
calculated from the information in Table 3A-10.
177
Design Example 3A
Mk
1
2
3
4
5
0.545(26.73)=14.58
0.76(10.48)=7.96
0.76(10.48)=7.96
0.31(10.48)=3.28
0.31(10.48)=3.28
Y
(in.)
0.00
14.54
14.54
15.07
15.07
Sum
A(y)2
Io
(in.4)
0
1,682
1,682
745
745
869
0
0
0
0
4,854
869
o.k.
With the beam web welded to the column, the plastic shear demand should be
checked against the beam shear strength. The plastic shear demand is calculated in
Part 6b above.
178
Design Example 3A
o.k.
FEMA 7.8.2
In this Design Example, the shear tab shown in Figure 3A-17 is present only for
steel erection. For beam web connections using shear tabs, the shear tab and bolts
are to be designed to resist the plastic beam shear Vp. The bolts must be slipcritical, and the shear tab may require a complete penetration weld to the column.
However, in September 1994, ICBO issued an emergency code change to the 1994
UBC, which deleted the prior requirement for supplemental welds from the shear
tab to the beam web. An example beam-column shear tab connection design is
given in Design Example 1A, Part 6g.
Check the through-thickness stress at the column.
Under FEMA 7.5.3.2, the through-thickness stresses at the interface of the beam
flange with the column face is determined as
f t t = M f Sc
FEMA 7.5.3.2
o.k.
6f.
179
Design Example 3A
Z C F yc f a
M C
1.0
where:
M Ct = VC ht ;
M Cb = VC + V f hb
and:
M C = M Ct + M Cb
V f is the incremental seismic shear to the column at the 3rd floor. From the
computer analysis (not shown): V f = 16.4 kips
Summing moments at the bottom of the lower column:
VC =
( )]
2 M pr + lh V p V f (hb + d P / 2)
(hb + d P + ht )
ht = hb =
VC =
180
Design Example 3A
The column moments, taken at the top and bottom of the panel zone are:
M Ct = 217.4(66.1) = 14,370 kip-in.
M Cb = (217.4 + 16.4 )(66.1) = 15,454 kip-in.
M C = 14,370 + 15,454 = 29,834 kip-in.
From Part 5b above, the maximum column axial stress is f a = 2.26 ksi . For the
W 14 283 column, Z x = 542 in.3 :
Z C Fyc f a
M C
o.k.
Therefore, the columns are stronger than the beam moments 2 M pr , and the strong
column-weak beam criteria is satisfied.
6g.
is the moment at the face of the column). The panel zone shear strength is derived
as follows:
181
Design Example 3A
Ff =
2 0.8 M f
H
2(0.8)M f
dp
162
2(0.8)(17,178)
= 933 kips
29.45
d b d c t
182
(13-1)
Design Example 3A
where:
bc =
db =
dc =
column depth
t cf =
t=
For the W 14 283 column, the panel zone shear strength is:
3 (16.11)(2.07 )2
V = 0.55(50 )(16.74)(1.29 ) 1 +
= 785 > 763 kips
(29.83)(16.74 )(1.29 )
o.k.
(13-1)
The W 14 283 column panel zone strength is just adequate when matched with
the W 30 108 beam without doubler plates. Again, this configuration is selected
in lieu of a lighter column with doubler plates as the most economical design. Note
that if the design does include doubler plates, then compliance with 2213.7.2.3 is
required.
The minimum panel zone thickness t z is also checked per 2213.7.2.2:
t z (d z + w z ) / 90
where:
d z = panel zone depth between continuity plates
wz = panel zone width between column flanges
t z = 1.29" for W 14 283
t z = 1.29" [(29.73 0.76) + (16.74 2.07 )/ 90] = 0.48 in.
o.k.
(13-2)
183
Design Example 3A
6h.
For W 30 108 :
Pbf = 1.8(0.76)(10.48)(50) = 717 kips
2213.7.4
Pbf F yc t wc (t b + 5k )
F yst
As the area calculated is negative, stiffeners are not required per Equation K1-9 of
AISC-ASD, and continuity plates with a thickness matching the beam flange are
adequate.
With complete penetration welds to the column flanges, the continuity plate
corners should be clipped to avoid the column k-area. This leaves a fillet weld
length to the column web of:
lw = d c 2(k ) = 16.74 2(2.75) = 11.2 in.
The fillet weld to the column web is designed for the tensile strength of the
continuity plate. Using a 3 4 " 7" plate on each side of the web (top and bottom),
the weld size is determined.
Plate strength:
Pst = 0.75 (7.0 ) 50.0 = 263 kips
184
Design Example 3A
Pst
( 263)
=
= 7.4
2lw (1.7 )(0.928) 2(11.2 )(1.7 )(0.928)
6i.
2213.7.7
o.k.
The column flanges therefore need lateral bracing only at the beam top flange. The
bracing force is taken at 1 percent of the beam flange capacity, perpendicular to the
plane of the frame. By observation, the bolted connection from the beam framing
perpendicular to the column is adequate.
6j.
FEMA 7.5.3.5
Lateral bracing is next considered for the beam flanges adjacent to the RBS cut. As
stated in FEMA 7.5.3.5, lateral braces for the top and bottom beam flanges are to
be placed within d/2 of the reduced section. (Note: This requirement is dropped in
FEMA-350 when a composite concrete slab is present. )
Lateral support of the top flange is ordinarily provided by shear studs to the
concrete fill over metal deck. Either diagonal angle bracing or perpendicular
beams can provide bottom flange lateral bracing. Generally, bracing elements may
be designed for about 2 percent of the compressive capacity of the member being
braced. Figure 3A-17 shows an example for angle bracing of the bottom flange.
185
Design Example 3A
6k.
Detailing considerations.
As noted in FEMA-267A, the reduced beam section SMRF design entails a few
unique considerations:
6l.
"
At the cut edge of the reduced section, the beam flange should be ground
parallel to the flange to a mirror finish (surface roughness < 1000 per
ANSI B46.1).
"
Shear studs should be omitted over the length of the cut in the beam top
flange, to minimize any slab influence on beam hinging.
"
A 1-inch-wide gap should be placed all around the column so as to the slab to
reduce the slab interaction with the column connection. (Note: FEMA-350 has
relaxed this requirement.)
Welding specifications.
To ensure that the SMRF joint welded connections are of the highest possible
quality, the design engineer must prepare and issue project-specific welding
specifications as part of the construction documents. The guidelines presented in
FEMA-267, Section 8.2 provide a comprehensive discussion of welding
specifications. For an itemized list of welding requirements, see California
Division of the State Architect (DSA), Interpretation of Regulations #27-8, Section
K Welding. A few of these requirements are noted below:
186
"
"
"
Pre-heat and interpass temperatures are to be strictly observed per AWS D1.1,
Chapter 4.2, and verified by the project inspector.
"
Weld dams are prohibited, and back-up bars (if used) should be removed, the
weld back-gouged, and a reinforced with a fillet weld.
"
Design Example 3A
6m.
187
Design Example 3A
References
AISC, 1997, 1999. Seismic Provisions for Structural Steel Buildings. American
Institute of Steel Construction, April 1997 with Supplement No. 1, February
1999,
DSA IR 27-8, 1998. Interpretation of Regulations 27-8. California Division of the
State Architect, Sacramento, California.
Englehardt, M., 1998. Design Recommendations for Radius Cut Reduced Beam
Section Moment Connections. University of Texas, Austin.
Englehardt, M., et al., 1996. The Dogbone Connection, Part II, Modern Steel
Construction. American Institute of Steel Construction.
FEMA-267, 1995. Interim Guidelines: Evaluation, Repair, Modification, and Design
of Welded Steel Moment Frame Structures. SAC Joint Venture, funded by the
Federal Emergency Management Agency, Washington, D.C.
FEMA-267A, 1997. Interim Guidelines Advisory No. 1, Supplement to FEMA-267,
Federal Emergency Management Agency, Washington, D.C.
FEMA-267B, 1999. Interim Guidelines Advisory No. 2, Supplement to FEMA-267,
Federal Emergency Management Agency, Washington, D.C.
Steel Tips, 1999. Design of Reduced Beam Section (RBS/Moment Frame
Connections, Steel Tips. Structural Steel Educational Council, Moraga,
California.
188
Design Example 3B
Design Example 3B
Steel Ordinary Moment Resisting Frame
Figure 3B-1. Four story steel office building with steel ordinary moment resisting frames (OMRF)
Foreword
Steel ordinary moment resisting frames (OMRF) differ from special moment
resisting frames (SMRF) in several important ways. The most significant
differences lie in the details of the beam-column joints and in the consideration of
strong column-weak beam effects in member selection. Because of these and other
factors, the SMRF structure has a higher R-factor (8.5) and no height limit, while
OMRF structures have a low R-factor (4.5) and are limited to 160 feet in height. In
general, SMRF structures are expected to perform much better in earthquakes than
OMRF structures.
This Design Example uses the same 4-story structure used in Design Example 3A
to illustrate design of a steel OMRF. The choice of this structure was based on both
convenience and the fact that the differences between OMRFs and SMRFs could
be easily shown.
189
Design Example 3B
It should be noted, however, that SEAOC does not recommend use of steel OMRFs
in buildings over two stories. In fact, SEAOC recommends use of SMRFs in all
steel moment frame structures of any height, particularly mid-rise and taller
structures, in high seismic regions. Typical uses of OMRF systems in high seismic
regions include structures such as one-story open front retail buildings, two-story
residential structures with open lower levels, penthouses and small buildings.
Overview
Steel ordinary moment resisting frames are required to meet the provisions of
2213.6. The OMRF requirements are essentially the same as stipulated in prior
UBC editions, and were not addressed in the emergency code amendment for
SMRF design issued in the 1996 Supplement to the 1994 UBC. However, both the
SEAOC Blue Book and FEMA-267 recommend against the use of OMRFs in
areas of high seismicity. The OMRF provisions are retained in the code for use in
light on- or two-story buildings, and structures in low seismic hazard zones.
The UBC requires OMRFs to be designed for about twice the lateral seismic force
that would be required for a SMRF in the same structure. As such, the plastic
rotation demand for OMRF connections should be roughly half that of the SMRF.
The connection ductility requirements for OMRFs are therefore less stringent than
for SMRFs. Notwithstanding code provisions, OMRF connections should receive
similar attention to joint detailing as for SMRFs. In particular, lessons learned from
the Northridge earthquake concerning weld procedures and filler materials should
also be applied to OMRFs.
As suggested in FEMA-267 (see p.7-2), OMRFs in areas of high seismicity may be
acceptable if the connections are designed to remain elastic for the design level
earthquake, while the beam and column members are designed per UBC OMRF
requirements. This can be achieved by applying an R factor of 1 in deriving design
base shear and confirming that the connection stresses do not exceed yield. This
enhanced OMRF design approach is also illustrated in this Design Example.
This Design Example uses the 4-story steel office structure from Design
Example 3A to illustrate OMRF design. The same building weights, frame
elevations and site seismicity are used as for Design Example 3A. Although this
Design Example is for a 4-story structure, the design procedure is applicable to all
OMRFs, including such uses as one-story, single bent frames at garage door
openings.
It is recommended that the reader first review Design Example 3A before reading
this Design Example. Refer to Example 3A for plans and elevations of the
structure.
190
Design Example 3B
Outline
This Design Example illustrates the following parts of the design process:
1.
2.
3.
Interstory drift.
4.
5.
1.
1a.
Code Reference
1629.6
The structure is a building frame system with lateral resistance provided by steel
ordinary moment resisting frames (system type 3.4.a of Table 16-N). The seismic
factors are:
R = 4.5
Table 16-N
= 2.8
hmax = 160 ft
1b.
1629.4.3
Table 16-Q
Table 16-R
191
Design Example 3B
1c.
1630.2.2
Per Method A:
(30-8)
T = Ct (hn )3 4
C t = 0.035
T A = 0.03(55.5)3 4 = 0.71 sec
Per Method B:
From Design Example 3A, assuming we retain the same beam and column sizes:
North-south:
(y ) : TBy
= 1.30 sec
1630.2.2
= 1.16 sec
Para. #2
East-west:
(x ) : TBx
For Seismic Zone 4, the value for Method B cannot exceed 130 percent of the
Method A period. Consequently,
Maximum value for TB = 1.3T A = 1.3(0.71) = 0.92 sec
1d.
Cv I
0.64(1.0 )
W =
W = 0.155W
RT
4.5(0.92 )
(30-4)
192
2.5C a I
2.5(0.44)(1.0 )
W =
W = 0.244W
R
4.5
(30-5)
Design Example 3B
(30-6)
0.8ZN v I
0.8(0.4)(1.0)(1.0)
W =
= 0.071W
R
4.5
(30-7)
1e.
(30-4)
Reliability/redundancy factor: = 2
20
rmax Ab
1630.1
(30-3)
(30-1)
(30-2)
Note that seismic forces may be assumed to act nonconcurrently in each principal
direction of the structure, except as per 1633.1.
193
Design Example 3B
2.
2a.
2b.
Level
W
(kips)
Roof
4th
3rd
2nd
2,066
2,235
2,235
2,235
Total
8,771
X cg
Ycg
(ft)
100
100
100
100
(ft)
70
70
70
70
M
(k-sec 2 / in.)
MMI
(k-sec 2-in.)
5.3
5.8
5.8
5.8
26,556
28,728
28,728
28,728
22.7
2c.
(30-4)
For the static lateral force procedure, vertical distribution of force to each level is
applied as follows:
V = Ft + Fi
(30-13)
where:
Ft = 0.07T (V ) 0.25(V )
Except Ft = 0
where:
T 0.7 sec
194
Design Example 3B
(30-15)
wx
(kips)
hx
(ft)
w x hx
(k-ft)
w x hx
wx
Fx
(kips)
V
(kips)
Roof
4th
3rd
2nd
2,066
2,235
2,235
2,235
55.5
42.0
28.5
15.0
114,663
93,870
63,698
33,525
0.375
0.307
0.208
0.110
564.8
390.6
265.1
139.5
564.8
955.4
1,220.5
1.000
1,360.0
1,360.0
Total
8,771
305,756
Note: Froof = 0.375 (1,272.4) + 87.6 = 564.8 kips
2d.
As in Design Example 3A, the direct seismic force, Fx , applied at the center of
mass is combined with an accidental torsional moment, M t , using a 5 percent
eccentricity, at each level. This is shown in Table 3B-3.
North-south:
M t = 0.05(204)Fx = (10.2)Fx
East-west:
M t = 0.05(144)Fx = (7.2 )Fx
195
Design Example 3B
Fx
(kips)
N-S M t
(k-ft)
E-W M t
(k-ft)
Roof
4th
3rd
2nd
564.8
390.6
265.1
139.5
5,761
3,984
2,704
1,423
4,067
2,812
1,909
1,004
With the direct seismic forces and torsional moments given in Table 3B-3 above,
the force distribution to the frames is generated by computer analysis (not shown).
For this Design Example, the beam and column sizes from Design Example 3A are
used in the computer model.
From the computer analysis, the shear force at the ground level is determined for
each frame column. Frame forces at the base of frame types A1 and B1 are
summarized in Tables 3B-4 and 3B-5.
Line A/1.2
(kips)
Direct Seismic
Torsion Force
Line A/2
(kips)
Line A/3
(kips)
Line A/4
(kips)
Line A/5
(kips)
79.4
143.1
132.6
132.6
143.1
4.9
8.8
8.2
8.2
8.8
4.9
43.8
151.9
84.3
754.0
84.3
Direct + Torsion
151.9
140.8
140.8
Line A/5.8
(kips)
79.4
Total
(kips)
710.2
Line 1/A.2
(kips)
3a.
Line 1/C
(kips)
113.1
113.1
Line 1/C.8
(kips)
Total
(kips)
Direct Seismic
63.1
Torsion Force
2.4
4.3
4.3
2.4
13.4
65.5
117.4
117.4
65.5
365.8
Direct + Torsion
3.
Line 1/B
(kips)
63.1
352.4
Interstory drift.
Determine S and M.
1630.9
Design Example 3B
(30-17)
The maximum values for S and M are determined, including torsional effects
(and including P effects for M ). Without the 1.3T A limit on TB , the design
base shear per Equation (30-4) is:
North-south:
TBy = 1.30 sec
Vn s =
Cv I
0.64(1.0)
W =
W = 0.109W = 956 kips
RT
4.5(1.30 )
(30-4)
East-west:
TBx = 1.16 sec
Ve w =
Cv I
0.64(1.0 )
W=
W = 0.123W = 1,079 kips
RT
4.5(1.16 )
1630.1.1
Note that 1630.1.1 stipulates use of the unfactored base shear (V ) , with = 1 .
Using these modified design base shears, the accidental torsion and force
distribution to each level are adjusted for input to the computer model. The
structure displacements and drift ratios are derived below in Table 3B-6.
Height
h (in.)
S drift
(in.)
M drift
(in.)
Drift Ratio
( M h )
4th
162
1.10
0.0068
3rd
162
1.70
0.0105
2nd
162
2.21
0.0136
1st
180
2.58
0.0143
Height
h (in.)
S drift
(in.)
M drift
(in.)
Drift Ratio
( M h )
4th
162
1.01
0.0062
3rd
162
1.61
0.0099
2nd
162
2.01
0.0124
1st
180
2.43
0.0135
197
Design Example 3B
3b.
1630.10
For structures with T > 0.7 seconds, the maximum allowable drift is: M = 0.020
(story height) per 1630.10.2. A review of the drift ratios tabulated above in
Table 3B-6 shows that all interstory drift ratios are less than 0.020, using the actual
period TB in base shear Equation (30-4). The maximum drift ratio of 0.0143
occurs at the first story in the north-south direction, and is a little more than
70 percent of the 0.020 allowable.
As expected, the maximum M displacements for the OMRF are very close to the
values for the SMRF from Design Example 3A. At this point in the design process,
the beam and column sizes could be reduced to make the displacements closer to
the code limit. However, using more conservative M drift ratios produces stiffer
frame designs, which mitigates possible deformation compatibility issues in other
elements such as cladding and non-frame (P ) column design. The same beam
and column sizes previously selected will be retained. The next step will be to
check member stress levels.
4.
2213.6
Using the W 30 108 beam and W 14 283 column from Design Example 3A (see
Figure 3A-3 for frame on Line A) for preliminary sizes, the OMRF frame members
are designed per 2213.6.
4a.
rd
The typical beam designed is the third floor beam shown in Figure 3B-2.
198
Design Example 3B
From a review of the computer output (not shown), the moments and shears at the
right end of the beam are greatest. Note that the seismic moment and shear are
about twice that for the SMRF example. The moments and shears, at the face of
the column at Line 5 are:
M DL = 1,042 kip-in.
M LL = 924 kip-in.
M seis = 6,780 kip-in.
M E = M seis = 1.25(6,780) = 8,475 kip-in.
V DL = 16.4 kips
V LL = 13.3 kips
Vseis = 42.2 kips
V E = Vseis = 1.25(42.2) = 52.7 kips
1630.1.1
Using the basic load combinations of 1612.3.1 (ASD), with no one-third increase.
D + L : M D +L = 1,042 + 924 = 1,966 kip-in.
(12-8)
E
8,475
: M D +E = 1,042 +
= 7,096 kip-in.
1.4
1.4
V D +E = 16.4 +
(12-9)
52.7
= 54.0 kips
1.4
8,475
E
D + 0.75 L +
= 6,275 kip-in.
: M D + L + E = 1,042 + 0.75924 +
1.4
1.4
(12-11)
52.7
V D + L+ E = 16.4 + 0.7513.3 +
= 54.6 kips
1.4
199
Design Example 3B
Check flange width-thickness ratios per AISC-ASD, Table B5.1 (Note: AISCASD is adopted, with amendments, in Division III of the code):
bf
2t f
65
50
= 9.19
and:
d
640
= 90.5
tw
50
For W 30 108 :
bf
2t f
o.k.
And:
d 29.83
=
= 54.7 < 90.5
t w 0.545
o.k.
( )
Fb = 0.60 Fy = 30.0 ks
Allowable M a = 299(30.0) = 8,970 kip-in. > 7,096 kip-in.
o.k.
200
Design Example 3B
For W 30 108 :
h 29.83 2(0.76 )
380
=
= 51.9 <
= 53.7
tw
0.545
50
( )
o.k.
4b.
nd
story.
201
Design Example 3B
(12-8)
9,376
E
: M D + E = 236 +
= 6,933 kip-in.
1.4
1.4
PD + E = 113 +
VD + E = 3.1 +
0.9 D
202
(12-9)
66
= 160 kips
1.4
134
= 99 kips
1.4
66
E
: PD E = 0.9(113)
= 54.5 kips compression
1.4
1.4
(12-10)
Design Example 3B
9,376
E
D + 0.75 L +
= 5,410 kip-in.
: M D + L + E = 236 + 0.75201 +
1.4
1.4
(12-11)
134
= 77 kips
VD + L + E = 3.1 + 0.752.7 +
1.4
66
PD + L + E = 113 + 0.7575 +
= 205 kips
1.4
Under the requirements of 2213.5.1, columns must have the strength to resist the
following axial load combinations (neglecting flexure):
PDL + 0.7 PLL + Pseis : Pcomp = 113 + 0.7(75) + 2.8(53) = 314 kips compression
0.85PDL Pseis :
f a 2.46
=
= 0.092 < 0.15
Fa 26.5
( )
203
Design Example 3B
E
f
f
160
6,933
: a + bx =
+
= 0.073 + 0.458 = 0.530 < 1.0
1.4 Fa Fb
83.3(26.5) 459(33.0 )
5,410
E f a f bx
+
= 0.092 +
= 0.449 < 1.0
:
D + 0.75 L +
459(33.0 )
1.4 Fa Fb
o.k.
o.k. (12-9)
(12-11)
o.k.
o.k.
Tension:
Pst = F y A = 50(83.3) = 4,165 kips >> 52 kips
o.k.
5.
2213.6
As shown above, the W 30 108 beam and W 14 283 column taken from the
SMRF of Design Example 3A have the capacity to meet the load combinations for
an OMRF per 1612.3. Section 2213.6 requires that OMRF beam-to-column
connections are to either meet the SMRF connection criteria (see 2213.7.1), or be
designed for gravity loads plus times the calculated seismic forces.
As discussed in FEMA-267 (Section 7.1), OMRF joints may be considered
acceptable if designed to remain elastic, with an R of unity (1.0). Using an R
factor of 1 is marginally more stringent than multiplying the seismic forces by o .
With R = 1 , it is appropriate to use the full calculated period (TBx = 1.30) to
determine the base shear for joint design. Therefore, the north-south base shear is
taken as:
Vn / s =
204
Cv I
0.64(1.0 )
W =
W = 0.492W = 4,315 kips
1.0(1.30 )
RT
Design Example 3B
For an OMRF (with = 2.8 ), the UBC base shear for connection design is:
Vn / s = 2.8(0.155)W = 0.434W = 3,807 kips
The ratio of base shears is:
FEMA/UBC = 4,315 / 3,807 = 1.13
Thus, there is a 13 percent increase with R = 1 as recommended in FEMA-267.
Using the unreduced seismic base shear, the beam-column joint stresses are
checked to remain elastic. For this, 1612.4, Special Seismic Load Combinations,
is used with a resistance factor of one.
5a.
The beam end moment and shear are scaled up to the unreduced seismic force
level by the ratio of the base shears, as follows:
0.492
VE ' =
Vseis = 3.17(42.2 ) = 138 kips
0.155
0.492
M E' =
M seis = 3.17(6,780 ) = 21,493 kip-in.
0.155
The special seismic load combination from 1612.4 is:
1.2 D + 0.5 L + 1.0 E M
(12-17)
205
Design Example 3B
5b.
As was done in Design Example 3A, the beam webs are to have
complete-penetration welds to the column flange. (Note that this weld is shown in
Figure 12-4). Note also that the flanges are reinforced with 5/16" fillet welds.
Using the cross-sectional area of the beam flange and web weldments at the face of
the column, the elastic section modulus S c of the beam is calculated from
information in Table 3B-7.
Area
(in.2)
1
2
3
4
5
0.545(26.73)=14.58
0.76(10.48)=7.96
0.76(10.48)=7.96
0.31(10.48)=3.28
0.31(10.48)=3.28
Sum
206
Y
(in.)
A(y)2
Io
(in.4)
0.00
14.54
14.54
15.07
15.07
0
1,682
1,682
745
745
869
0
0
0
0
4,854
869
Design Example 3B
n.g.
The W 30 108 connection (weld) stresses to the column are not within the elastic
limit. At this point, we can choose to either add cover plates, or make the beam
larger. With similar weld patterns, a W 33 152 is required to obtain an adequate
connection section modulus S c = 575 in.3 :
o.k.
If we choose to instead add cover plates, we would need 10" 3 / 4" plates at the top
and bottom flanges. With complete penetration welds at the cover plates to the
column, the increased moment of inertia and section modulus are:
I c = 5,723 + 2(7.5)(15.3)2 = 9,234 in.3
S c = 9,234 15.98 = 578 in.3
and:
f weld = 23,205 / 578 = 40.1 ksi < 50 ksi
o.k.
The cover plates should be about half the beam depth in length, with fillet welds to
the beam flange as required to develop the tensile capacity of the plate. The
minimum size for " plate is a 5/16" fillet weld.
Cover plate capacity:
TPl = 0.75(10 )(50.0 ) = 375 kips
207
Design Example 3B
o.k.
As noted above, the beam web is to have a complete penetration weld to the
column face. The allowable beam shear of 325 kips from Part 4a above exceeds
the unreduced seismic shear demand of 164 kips. For beam-to-column connections
with bolted shear plates in lieu of welded webs, the connection plate and bolts
must be designed for this maximum shear force. See Design Example 3A, Part 6g
for a beam-to-column shear plate connection design.
5c.
Additional considerations.
Although the UBC does not explicitly require any further OMRF connection
analysis, it is good practice to check the strong column-weak beam criteria and the
column panel zone shear strength. The column panel zone shear strength should be
reviewed for capacity to resist the maximum beam moment from the unreduced
seismic force. The strong column-weak beam analysis would be similar to that of
the SMRF Design Example 3A, Part 6f. The OMRF joint should also include
continuity plates, and expanded welding procedures as for the SMRF.
OMRFs designed to comply with the foregoing parameters can be expected to
provide a high level of seismic performance. The objective of maintaining
connection stresses within the elastic range is shown to be reasonable even for the
unreduced seismic demand. The resulting frame design produces a structure that
may respond to the design level ground motion without damage (i.e., plastic
deformations). Moreover, OMRF designs will likely produce nominally heavier
members, thereby reducing overall building drift and decreasing the potential for
damage to nonstructural components.
208
Design Example 4
Design Example 4
Reinforced Concrete Wall
Overview
The structure in this Design Example is an 8-story parking garage with loadbearing reinforced concrete walls (shear walls) as its lateral force resisting system,
as shown in Figure 4-1. This Design Example focuses on the design and detailing
of one of the 30'-6" long walls running in the transverse building direction.
The purpose of this Design Example is twofold:
1.
Demonstrate the design of a solid reinforced concrete walls for flexure and
shear, including bar cut-offs and lap splices.
2.
209
Design Example 4
The Design Example assumes that design lateral forces have already been
determined for the structure, and that the forces have been distributed to the walls
of the structure by a hand or computer analysis. This analysis has provided the
lateral displacements corresponding to the design lateral forces.
Outline
This Design Example illustrates the following parts of the design process:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Given Information
The following information is given:
Seismic zone = 4
Soil profile type = S D
Near field = 5 km from seismic source type A
Reliability/redundancy factor, = 1.0
Importance factor, I = 1.0
Concrete strength, f ' c = 5,000 psi
Steel yield strength, f y = 60 ksi
Figure 4-2 shows the typical floor plan of the structure. Figure 4-3 shows the wall
elevation and shear and moment diagrams. The wall carries axial forces PD
(resulting from dead load including self-weight of the wall) and PL (resulting from
live load) as shown in Table 4-1. Live loads have already been reduced according
to 1607.5. The shear V E and moment M E resulting from the design lateral
earthquake forces are also shown in Table 4-1.
210
Design Example 4
211
Design Example 4
PD
(k)
PL
(k)
VE
(k)
ME
(k-ft)
216
436
643
851
1060
1270
1470
1730
41
81
122
162
203
244
284
325
96
262
438
625
821
1030
1270
1470
0
0
960
3760
8530
15400
24400
35600
49600
75500
For this Design Example, it is assumed that the foundation system is rigid and the
wall can be considered to have a fixed base. The fixed-base assumption is made
here primarily to simplify the example. In an actual structure, the effect of
foundation flexibility and its consequences on structural deformations and strains
should be considered.
Using the fixed base assumption and effective section properties, the horizontal
displacement at the top of the wall, corresponding to the design lateral forces, is
2.32 inches. This displacement is needed for the detailing of boundary zones
according to the UBC strain calculation procedure of 1921.6.6, which is
illustrated in Part 7 of this Design Example.
The design and analysis of the structure is based on an R factor of 4.5 (UBC
Table 16-N) for a bearing wall system with concrete shear walls. Concrete wall
structures can also be designed using an R factor of 5.5, if an independent space
frame is provided to support gravity loads. Such a frame is not used in this Design
Example.
1.
Code Reference
Load combinations for the seismic design of concrete are given in 1612.2.1. (This
is indicated in 1909.2.3, and in the definition of Design Load Combinations in
1921.1.) Equations (12-5) and (12-6) of UBC Chapter 16 are the seismic design
load combinations to be used for concrete.
Exception 2 of 1612.2.1 states Factored load combinations of this section
multiplied by 1.1 for concrete and masonry where load combinations include
seismic forces. Thus, the load combinations for Equations (12-5) and (12-6) for
the seismic design of concrete can be written:
212
Design Example 4
1630.1.1
The term E in the load combinations includes horizontal and vertical components
according to Equation (30-1):
E = E h + E v
(30-1)
f2S )
(1.2 + 0.5C a I )D + E h + ( f1 L +
f2S )
0.9 D E h
213
Design Example 4
For this Design Example, it is assumed that the local building department has
indicated approval of the SEAOC recommended revisions to the UBC load
combinations. For examples using the UBC load combinations instead of the
SEAOC recommendations, see Seismic Design Manual Volume II.
Since the given structure is a parking garage, f1 = 1.0 , per 1612.2.1, and since
there is no snow load, S = 0 .
For Soil Profile Type S D , Seismic Zone 4, the factor C a is calculated as 0.44 N a ,
according to Table 16-Q. From Table 16-S, the factor N a is given as 1.2 (5km
from Seismic Source Type A). However, the structure meets all of the conditions
of 1629.4.2 and therefore the value of N a need not exceed 1.1.
Thus, C a = 0.44(1.1) = 0.484 . With I = 1.0 and = 1.0 , the governing load
combinations for this Design Example are:
For the example wall, the dead and live loads cause axial load only, and the
earthquake forces produce shear and moment only. The second of the above
combinations gives the lower bound axial load. For a wall with axial loads below
the balance point, the lower bound axial load governs the design for moment
strength. (Typically, axial loads in concrete walls are well below the balance point,
as is the case in this Design Example, as shown in Figure 4-8).
The governing axial load at the base of the wall is thus:
Pu = 0.9 PD = 0.9 (1,730 k ) = 1,560 k
The governing moment and shear at the base of the wall is:
M u = M E = 75,500 k - ft
Vu = V E = 1,470 k - ft
214
Design Example 4
2.
2a.
Say b = 20 in.
2b.
1921.6.6(1.1)
For structures with tall story heights, the designer should check that the wall
thickness exceeds l u 16 , where l u is the clear height between floors that brace the
wall out-of-plane. This is based on 1921.6.6.6, paragraph 1.1, applicable to walls
that require boundary confinement. The SEAOC Blue Book Commentary
(C407.5.6, page 178) recommends that the wall boundary thickness limit of l u 16
be applied at all potential plastic hinge locations, regardless of whether boundary
zone confinement is required.
For the example wall, the clear height at the first story is 17 feet.
Minimum thickness = l u 16 = 17 (12) 16 = 12.8" < 20"
o.k.
215
Design Example 4
2c.
"
"
216
o.k.
Design Example 4
3.
3a.
217
Design Example 4
Pn
Mn
CS2
CS1
TS2
TS1
CC
fy Steel stress,
cyclic loading
-fy
Steel stress,
monotonic loading
218
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Cc = (Pn + Ts Cs ) .
Design Example 4
3b.
Hand calculation.
8 ft
x
PN
CS1
TS3
CS2
TS2
TS1
CC
The iterative calculation of neutral axis depth and moment strength is shown in
Tables 4-2 and 4-3 below.
1909.2
Reinforcement
Bars
As
in.2
Asfy
kips
3-#11
12-#11
54-#8
12-#11
3-#11
4.68
18.7
42.7
18.7
4.68
-281
-1122
2562
1122
281
1910
-4472
0
x
in.
Asfy*x
kip-in.
3
34.5
183
332
363
183
26.3
-842
-38,700
469,000
373,000
102,000
350,000
-126,000
1,130,000
=Mn (kip-in.)
219
Design Example 4
Reinforcement
Bars
As
in.2
3-#11
12-#11
52-#8
12-#11
3-#11
4.68
18.7
41.1
18.7
4.68
Asfy
kips
x
in.
-281
-1122
2465
1122
281
1910
-4375
0
Asfy*x
kip-in.
3
34.5
187
332
363
183
25.7
-842
-38,709
460,918
372,504
101,930
349,530
-123,369
1,121,961=Mn (kip-in.)
93,497=Mn (kip-ft)
Therefore, 15-#11 bars yield in compression, 54-#8 bars (all web vertical
bars) plus 15-#11 bars yield in tension. (Assume all reinforcement yields in
either tension or compression.)
Solve for C c to balance forces, C c = 4,470 kips
a = 52.6
c = 65.8
Therefore, 15-#11 bars yield in compression, 52-#8 bars plus 15-#11 bars yield in
tension. Neglect force in 2-#8 located at x = 67 inches. Therefore, centroid of 52-#8
bars is at x = 187 in. Assume all other reinforcement yields.
Solve for C c to balance forces, C c = 4,375 kips
a = 51.5
c = 64.3
solution converged
220
o.k.
Design Example 4
3c.
3d.
Calculation by PCACOL.
The computer program PCACOL can also be used to design wall sections for
flexure and axial load. The example wall section was run on PCACOL and the
moment strength obtained was the same as that calculated by the hand and
spreadsheet methods. The printed screen output of the PCACOL run is shown in
Figure 4-8.
221
Design Example 4
222
Design Example 4
4.
4a.
Bar cut-offs.
1912.10.3
223
Design Example 4
Vertical Bars
Each Boundary
Web Vertical
Bars
Level 1 Level 5
Level 5 Level 7
Level 7 Level 9
15-#11
15-#10
15-#8
54-#8
54-#7
54-#6
Axial Load
Pu=0.9PD
1560 k
766 k
392 k
Design Moment
Strength, Mn
76,200 k-ft
59,200 k-ft
40,400 k-ft
The moment strengths for each reinforcement arrangement were calculated using
the spreadsheet procedure described in Part 3c, above.
The moment strength above Level 5 is checked by the calculation below. For
simplicity, the moment diagram is assumed to be linear over the building height.
This also addresses higher mode effects according to the recommendations of
Paulay and Priestley [1992].
Height of reinforcement cut-off above base
Height after subtracting 0.8l w bar extension
Moment demand M u at the base of the wall
Overall wall height, hw
Moment demand at h = 29.8' based on linear
moment diagram
= 54.2'
= 29.8'
= 75,500 k-ft
= 95.3'
= (75,500)(95.3 29.8)/95.3
= 51,900 k-ft.
< 59,200 o.k.
= 75.9'
= 51.5'
= (75,500)(95.3 51.5)/95.3
= 34,700 k-ft.
< 40,400 o.k.
The calculations for bar cut-off locations are illustrated in Figure 4-9.
224
Design Example 4
Amount of
vertical
reinforcement
Moment demand
assuming
linear variation
4b.
Splices of reinforcement.
The lap splices of the vertical reinforcement are shown in the wall elevation of
Figure 4-11. Lap splice lengths are taken from the CRSI rebar detailing chart
[CRSI, 1996]. Lap splices are not used over the first two stories of the wall,
because this is the anticipated plastic hinge region.
Although not specifically required by the code, lap splices of flexural
reinforcement should be avoided in plastic hinge regions of walls. As indicated in
1999 Blue Book Sections C402.7 and C404.3 (and in the commentary to Section
21.3.2 of ACI 318 [1999], applicable to flexural members of frames), lap splices in
plastic hinge regions are likely to slip unless they are surrounded by confining ties.
Even well-confined lap splices (C402.7) that do not slip are undesirable in plastichinge regions because they prevent an even distribution of yielding along the
length of the flexural reinforcement.
Paulay and Priestley [1992] note that splices in plastic hinge zones tend to
progressively unzip and that attempting to mitigate the problem by making lap
splices longer than required is unlikely to ensure satisfactory performance.
225
Design Example 4
1921.2.6
1921.6.6.5
Section 1921.6.6.5 specifies that the equivalent plastic hinge length, l p , of a wall
section shall be established on the basis of substantiated test data or may be
alternatively taken as 0.5l w . Based on the work of Paulay and Priestley [1993]
and FEMA-306 [1999], l p for walls can be taken as 0.2lw + 0.07 M V , where
M V is the moment to shear ratio at the plastic hinge location.
For the example wall, l p is calculated by both methods as shown below:
l p = 0.5l w
= 0.5(30.5')
= 15.2'
l p = 0.2l w + 0.07 M V
For this Design Example, we will take 9.7 ft as l p , based on the substantiated test
data reviewed by Paulay and Priestley [1993].
Equivalent plastic hinge lengths, as calculated above, are used to relate plastic
curvatures to plastic rotations and displacements (for example in 1921.6.6.5). The
actual zone of yielding and nonlinear behavior typically extends beyond the
equivalent plastic hinge length. For flexural members of frames, 1921.3.2.3
indicates that flexural yielding may be possible within a distance of twice the
member depth from the face of the joint. This distance is conservatively defined
to be larger, by a factor of two or more, than the equivalent plastic hinge length, lp.
Thus, for this Design Example wall, the expected zone of yielding should be taken
as equal to at least 2l p (19.4 ft), and lap splices should be avoided over this height.
In the Design Example, lap splices are excluded over the first two stories, i.e., over
a height of 28.8 ft, as shown in the wall elevation of Figure 4-10. Because of
potential construction difficulties in using continuous vertical bars from the
226
Design Example 4
5.
The SEAOC Blue Book Section 402.8.1 requires that the design shear strength
Vn shall not be less than the shear associated with the development of the
nominal moment strength of the wall. A design for shear forces based on code
requirements will not necessarily achieve this objective. Thus, the code provisions
covered in Part 5(a) should be considered as minimum requirements for the shear
design of walls.
Designing for amplified shear forces as recommended in the Blue Book is covered
in Part 5(b) below.
227
Design Example 4
5a.
UBC requirements.
Shear demand.
If designing to the minimum requirements of the UBC, the shear demand is taken
directly from the design forces, factored by the load combinations discussed in
Part 1 of this Design Example. At the base of the wall:
Vu = V E = 1,470 k
Shear capacity.
Section 1911.10 gives shear provisions for walls designed for nonseismic lateral
forces such as wind or earth pressure. Section 1921.6.5 gives shear strength
provisions for walls designed for seismic forces.
Since the subject wall has a ratio of hw l w greater than 2.0, Equation (21-6)
governs wall shear strength:
Vn = Acv 2 f ' c + n f y
228
VE
kips
95
262
438
625
821
1030
1260
1470
Horizontal
Reinforcement
Vn
kips
#5@12 E.F.
#5@12 E.F.
#5@12 E.F.
#5@12 E.F.
#5@12 E.F.
#5@12 E.F.
#5@12 E.F.
#6@12 E.F.
0.00258
0.00258
0.00258
0.00258
0.00258
0.00258
0.00258
0.00367
1300
1300
1300
1300
1300
1300
1300
1585
Design Example 4
UBC 1921.6.5.6 requires that Vn shall not be taken greater than 8 Acv
8 Acv
5b.
f 'c .
o.k.
To comply with the Blue Book requirement of providing shear strength in excess
of the shear corresponding to wall flexural strength, an amplified shear demand is
considered.
Section C402.8 of the Blue Book commentary gives the following equation for the
shear amplification factor, v , that accounts for inelastic dynamic effects. For
application to designs according to the UBC, the amplification factor
recommended by Paulay and Priestley [1992] can be reduced by a factor of 0.85,
because the Paulay and Priestley recommendations use a different strength
reduction factor, , than does the UBC.
v
As indicated in the Blue Book, the v factor is derived for analysis using inverted
triangular distributions of lateral forces. If a response spectrum analysis is carried
out, a slightly lower v factor can be justified in some cases.
For this Design Example, the shear demand is taken at the nominal strength. For
further conservatism, one could base the shear demand on the upper bound of
flexural strength, which can be taken as the probable flexural strength, Mpr,
defined in 1921.0.
M n is calculated using a strength reduction factor, , of 1.0, and taking the upper
bound of axial load from the load combinations of UBC 1921.0. The probable and
nominal moment strengths for the higher axial load are as shown in Table 4-6. The
nominal moment strength previously calculated is shown for comparison.
=2820 k
=2820 k
=1560 k
Reinforcement Strength
1.25 fy = 75 ksi
fy = 60 ksi
fy = 60 ksi
Moment Strength
Mpr = 125,000 k-ft
Mpr = 111,000 k-ft
Mn = 93,500 k-ft
229
Design Example 4
At the base of the wall, the magnified shear demand Vu * is calculated as follows:
Vu * = v (M n M u )(VE )= 1.33(111,000 k ft 75,500 k ft )(1,470 k ) = 2,870 k
Shear capacity.
Since this Design Example uses nominal shear strength to exceed the shear
corresponding to flexural strength, a strength reduction factor, , of 0.85 can be
used. As before, Equation (21-6) is used to calculated shear capacity:
1921.6.5
For the shear demand of 2870 k, the required amount of horizontal reinforcement is
calculated:
n = (2,870 k 880 k ) 373,000 = 0.00535
Try #8 @ 12" o.c. each face
n = 2 0.79 in.2
o.k.
This amount of shear reinforcement is provided over the bottom two stories of the
wall. For the other stories, the recommended amount of horizontal reinforcement,
based on the magnified shear demand Vu*, is calculated as shown in Table 4-7.
VE
(k)
95
262
438
625
821
1030
1260
1470
Vu*
(k)
186
512
856
1220
1610
2010
2460
2870
Horizontal
Reinforcement
#5@12 E.F.
#5@12 E.F.
#5@12 E.F.
#5@12 E.F.
#5@12 E.F.
#7@12 E.F.
#8@12 E.F.
#8@12 E.F.
0.00258
0.00258
0.00258
0.00258
0.00258
0.00500
0.00658
0.00658
Vn
(k)
1841
1841
1841
1841
1841
2742
3331
3331
Paulay and Priestley [1992] recommend equations for shear strength that are
somewhat different than Equation (21-6), and in which the shear strength at plastic
hinge zones is taken to be less than that at other wall locations. For the wall design
in this Design Example, the Paulay and Priestley shear strength equations result in
nearly identical amounts of horizontal reinforcement as does Equation (21-6).
230
Design Example 4
5c.
A comparison of Tables 4-6 and 4-7 shows that the Blue Book recommendation
(C407.2.5) of providing shear strength that exceeds flexural strength results in
more horizontal reinforcement in the bottom three stories of the wall than that
required by the code. The Blue Book approach is recommended by SEAOC, as it
leads to more ductile wall behavior.
In the upper five stories of the wall, the code minimum amount of horizontal steel
( n = 0.0025) is adequate to meet both the UBC requirements and the Blue Book
recommendations. Overall, the additional cost of heavier bars in the first three
stories, as determined under the Blue Book requirements, should not be significant.
The wall elevation of Figure 4-10 shows the horizontal reinforcement per the Blue
Book recommendation.
6.
1911.7
At construction joints and flexural plastic hinge zones, walls can be vulnerable to
sliding shear. Typically lowrise walls are more vulnerable. If construction joint
surfaces are properly prepared according to 1911.7.9, taller walls should not be
susceptible to sliding shear failure.
Sliding shear can be checked using the shear friction provisions of 1911.7. Shear
strength is computed by Equation (11-25):
Vn = Avf f y
is the coefficient of friction, which is taken as 1.0 , where = 1.0 for normal
weight concrete.
Avf is the amount of shear-transfer reinforcement that crosses the potential sliding
plane. For the wall in this Design Example, all vertical bars in the section are
effective as shear-transfer reinforcement [ACI-318 Commentary R11.7.7]. At the
base of the wall:
) (
231
Design Example 4
Vn = Avf f y + 0.9 PD
[(
o.k.
By inspection, the sliding shear capacity at higher story levels of the building is
also okay.
7.
The code gives two alternatives for determining whether or not boundary zone
detailing needs to be provided: a simplified procedure, 1921.6.6.4, and a strain
calculation procedure, 1921.6.6.5.
7a.
1921.6.6.4
and either:
M u (Vu l w ) 1.0
or:
Vu 3 Acv
232
f 'c
Design Example 4
Use of this procedure for the wall in this Design Example is shown below:
Pu = 1.44 PD + PL = 2,820 k
0.10 Ag f ' c = 0.10(20" 366")(5.0 ksi ) = 3,660 k > 2,820 k
M u (Vu l w ) = 75,000 k ft [(1,470 k )(30.5')] = 1.68 > 1.0
3 Acv f 'c = 3(20"366") 5,000 psi = 1,550,000# = 1,550 k > Vu = 1,470 k
Therefore, boundary zone detailing as defined in 1921.6.6.6 is not required.
7b.
1921.6.6.5
i
hw l p 2 l p
1630.9.2
where i = t y
and t = m ,when the analysis has used effective stiffness
(cracked section) properties
m is defined in Equation (30-17) of 1630.9.2 as
m = 0.7 R s
s is the design level response displacement. For the example wall at the top, it is
the displacement s = 2.32 inches, taken from the analysis.
m = 0.7 R s = 0.7(4.5)(2.32") = 7.32"
y is the yield displacement of the wall, taken as M ' n M E E . For the example
233
Design Example 4
M'n
= 2240 k
Reinforcement
Strength
fy = 60 ksi
Moment Strength
M'n = 103,000 k-ft
Neutral Axis
Depth
c'u = 78.0
4.15"
+ 0.003 366" = 29.8(10 )6 in.1
(1,140"183" 2)183"
The compressive strain at the extreme fiber of the section equals the total curvature
times the neutral axis depth:
7c.
Section 402.11 of the Blue Book modifies the UBC, including a revised formula
for t that gives a more realistic estimate of inelastic seismic displacements and
corrects a tendency for the UBC strain calculation procedure to give
unconservative results. Section 402.11.1 of the 1999 Blue Book replaces the
definition of t to give:
t = R s
234
Design Example 4
7.28"
+ 0.003 366" = 46.1(10)6
(1,140"183" 2)183"
The compressive strain at the extreme fiber of the section equals the product of the
total curvature and the neutral axis depth:
235
Design Example 4
References
ATC-43, 1999. Evaluation of Earthquake Damaged Concrete and Masonry Wall
Buildings, prepared by the Applied Technology Council (ATC-43 project) for
the Partnership for Response and Recovery. Federal Emergency Management
Agency, Report No. FEMA-306, Washington, D.C.
CRSI, 1996. Rebar Design and Detailing Data ACI. Concrete Reinforcing Steel
Institute, Schaumberg, Illinois.
Maffei, Joe, 1996. Reinforced Concrete Structural Walls Beyond the Code,
SEAONC Fall Seminar Proceedings. Structural Engineers Association of
Northern California, San Francisco, California, November.
Paulay, T., and M.J.N. Priestley, 1992. Reinforced Concrete and Masonry Buildings,
Design for Seismic Resistance. John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York. (Chapter
5 covers seismic behavior and design of reinforced concrete walls, including
examples. The book is not based on the ACI or UBC codes, but explains the
principles that underlie several code provisions.)
Paulay, T., and M.J.N. Priestley, 1993. Stability of Ductile Structural Walls. ACI
Structural Journal, Vol. 90, No. 4, July-August 1993.
PCA, 1999. PCACOL: Design and Investigation of Reinforced Concrete Column
Sections, Portland Cement Association, Skokie, Illinois.
236
Design Example 5
Design Example 5
Reinforced Concrete Wall with Coupling Beams
Overview
The structure in this Design Example is a 6-story office building with reinforced
concrete walls (shear walls) as its lateral force resisting system. The example
focuses on the design and detailing of one of the reinforced concrete walls. This is
a coupled wall running in the transverse building direction and is shown in
Figure 5-1. The example assumes that design lateral forces have already been
determined for the building, and that the seismic moments, shears, and axial loads
on each of the wall components, from the computer analysis, are given.
237
Design Example 5
The purpose of this Design Example is to illustrate the design of coupling beams
and other aspects of reinforced concrete walls that have openings. Research on the
behavior of coupling beams for concrete walls has been carried out in New
Zealand, the United States, and elsewhere since the late 1960s. The code provisions
of the UBC derive from this research.
Outline
This Design Example illustrates the following parts of the design process:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Given Information
The following information is given:
Seismic zone = 4
Soil profile type = S D
Near-field = 5 km from seismic source type A
Redundancy/reliability factor, = 1.0
Importance factor, I = 1.0
Concrete strength, f 'c = 4000 psi
Steel yield strength, f y = 60 ksi
The wall to be designed, designated Wall 3, is one of several shear walls in the
building. The wall elevation, a plan section, and the design forces are shown in
Figure 5-2. An elastic analysis of the wall for lateral forces, using a computer
program, gives the results shown in Figure 5-3, which shows the moments and
shear for each coupling beam (i.e., wall spandrel), and the moments, shear and
axial forces for each vertical wall segment (i.e., wall pier).
238
Design Example 5
Plan
Elevation
Figure 5-2. Wall elevation, plan section, and design forces of Wall 3
239
Design Example 5
Units:
P=kips beam moment at edge of wall piers
V=kips pier moments at floor levels
M=kips-inch
240
Design Example 5
1.
Code Reference
f2S )
0.9 D Eh
Since the given structure is an office building, f1 = 0.5 . And since there is no snow
load, S = 0 .
The same seismic zone, soil profile, near-field, redundancy, and importance factors
are assumed as for Design Example 4, thus C a = 0.484 . With I = 1.0 and = 1.0 ,
the governing load combinations for this Design Example are:
0.9 D Eh
[1.2 0.5(0.484)]D Eh + L
= 1.44 D Eh + 0.5 L
= 0.958D Eh + 0.5L
2.
For walls with diagonally reinforced coupling beams, the required wall thickness is
often dictated by the layering of the reinforcement in the coupling beam. Typically,
a wall thickness of 15 inches or larger is required for diagonally reinforced
coupling beams conforming to the 1997 UBC.
For the subject wall, a wall thickness, bw , of 16 inches will be tried.
241
Design Example 5
3.
3a.
Roof
6th
5th
4th
3rd
2nd
4th
3rd
2nd
Vu
(kips)
151
325
447
211
180
285
319
454
406
h
(in.)
72
72
72
72
72
120
72
72
120
d
(in.)
57.6
57.6
57.6
57.6
57.6
96.0
57.6
57.6
96.0
Vu bw d f 'c
(1)
Diagonal
Bars
Ad
(in.2)
(degrees)
Vn
(kips)
Vn Vu
4-#8
4-#10
6-#10
4-#9
4-#9
4-#9
6-#9
6-#10
4-#10
3.16
5.08
7.62
4.00
4.00
4.00
6.00
7.62
5.08
37.9
37.9
36.0
37.9
37.9
53.1
36.0
36.0
53.1
198
318
456
251
251
326
359
456
414
1.31
0.98
1.02
1.19
1.39
1.14
1.13
1.00
1.02
2.6
5.6
7.7
3.6
3.1
2.9
5.5
7.8
4.2
242
Design Example 5
3b.
(21-1)
Each group of diagonal bars must consist of at least 4 bars (1921.6.10.2). The
calculation of the required diagonal reinforcement is shown in Table 5-1. For
coupling beams with higher shear stresses, 6 bars are needed in each group, as
shown in Table 5-1.
The angle of the diagonal bars is calculated based on the geometry of the
reinforcement layout, as shown in Figure 5-4. The value of depends somewhat
on overall dimension of the diagonal bar group and on the clearance between the
diagonal bar group and the corner of the wall opening. This affects the dimension x
shown in Figure 5-4 and results in a slightly different value of for a group of
6 bars compared to that for a group of 4 bars, as shown in Table 5-1.
The provided diagonal bars are shown in Figure 5-5.
243
Design Example 5
4.
The design of the vertical wall segments for flexure is carried out following the
procedures and recommendations given for conventional solid walls. This is
shown in Part 3 of Design Example 4. From Figure 5-3, the critical wall segments
(i.e., those with the highest moments or earthquake axial forces) include the wall
pier at the 4th floor on Line D, and the wall piers at the base on Lines C and E. The
20-foot long wall pier on Line D at the base is also checked.
244
Design Example 5
4a.
As can be seen from Figure 5-2, the gravity loads on each wall pier are not
concentric with the wall pier centroid. Therefore, gravity load moments must be
considered in the design of flexural reinforcement. The dead and live loads (except
wall self-weight shown in Table 5-2) in Figure 5-2 act at the column grid lines, and
have an eccentricity, eDF , with respect to the section centroid, as given in
Table 5-3 (Note: The calculation of weights, section centroids, eDF, and eDW is not
shown). The wall self-weight provides additional dead load at each level, equal to
the values given in Table 5-2.
Line C
Sum of Wall
Eccentricity,
Weight (kips)
eDW (ft) (1)
26
53
79
106
132
166
2.06
2.06
2.06
2.06
2.06
2.03
Line D
Sum of Wall
Eccentricity,
Weight (kips)
eDW (ft) (1)
26
53
79
132
185
252
-2.06
-2.06
-2.06
-3.71
-2.65
-1.94
Line E
Sum of Wall
Eccentricity,
Weight (kips)
eDW (ft) (1)
0
0
0
26
53
86
-2.06
-2.06
-2.00
Note:
1. eDW = distance between centroid of weight and centroid of wall section.
The calculation of the factored forces on the critical wall piers is shown in
Table 5-3. In this table, gravity moments are calculated about the section centroid,
using the gravity loads acting at the column centerline, PDF and PL , plus the dead
load from wall self-weight, PDW. Earthquake moments, ME, are taken from
Figure 5-3.
Loads are factored according to the combinations discussed in Part 1 of this Design
Example, giving two cases for each wall pier: minimum axial load and maximum
axial load. The minimum axial load case is based on the combination of Eh with
0.9 D , and the maximum axial load case is based on the combination of Eh with
1.44 D + 0.5 L .
Considering that larger axial compression generally increases moment strength,
potentially governing combinations are shown as shaded areas in Table 5-3.
245
Design Example 5
Table 5-3. Calculation of factored axial forces and moments on critical wall piers
Level Line
4th
4th
1st
1st
1st
1st
1st
D
D
C
C
E
E
D
PDF eDR
(kips) (ft)
428
428
874
874
874
874
874
PDW e DW PL Direction PE
(kips) (ft) (kips) of force (kips)
-4.13 79
-4.13 79
4.13 166
4.13 166
-4.13 86
-4.13 86
0
252
-2.06
-2.06
2.03
2.03
-2.00
-2.00
-1.94
44
44
100
100
100
100
100
west
east
west
east
west
east
west
-923
923
1,600
-1,600
-1,179
1,179
-421
ME
(k-ft)
-6,070
6,070
-4,105
4,105
-4,191
4,191
-13,250
MD
M L Minimum Axial Maximum Axial
MU
PU
MU
(k-ft) (k-ft) PU
1,603
1,603
-3,268
-3,268
3,433
3,433
-489
182
182
-413
-413
413
413
0
-467 -4,628
1,379 7,512
2,536 -7,047
-664 1,164
-315 -1,101
2,043 7,281
592 -13,690
-171 -3,671
1,675 8,469
3,148 -9,018
-52
-807
253
959
2,611 9,341
1,250 -13,954
Notes:
PDF = dead load distributed over floor area, which acts at the column line.
e DF = distance between PDF and centroid of wall section.
PDW = dead load from wall self-weight.
e DW = distance between PDW and centroid of wall section.
4b.
Vertical reinforcement.
The program PCACOL [PCA, 1999] is used to design the reinforcement in each
wall pier. Figure 5-6 shows a wall section with the typical layout of vertical
reinforcement. Typical reinforcement in the column portion of the wall piers is
8-#9 and typical vertical reinforcement in the wall web is #7@12. The PCACOL
results of Figure 5-7a, 5-7b, and 5-7c show that this reinforcement is adequate in
all locations except Line D at the 4th floor where 8-#10 are required instead of 8-#9.
Figure 5-7d shows that the typical reinforcement provides adequate moment
strength to the 20-foot long wall pier on Line D.
Figure 5-8 shows the vertical reinforcement provided in the wall piers to satisfy
moment strength requirements. Note that the vertical reinforcement in the column
portion of the 4th floor piers is increased to 8-#11 (from 8-#9 used at the lower
levels), and that at the 5th and 6th floors is increased to 8-#10. The reasons for this
will be discussed in Part 5 of this Design Example.
Design Example 5
a.
b.
c.
d.
247
Design Example 5
4c.
248
Design Example 5
5.
This part of the Design Example presents a plastic analysis methodology that is not
a code requirement. It is included to assist the reader in understanding the postelastic behavior of coupled shear walls and how they can be analyzed for seismic
forces when elements of the wall are yielding.
Plastic analyses are not required by the UBC, but they are recommended in the
SEAOC Blue Book: 1.) to establish shear demand corresponding to flexural
strength, and 2.) to identify potential plastic hinge regions where special boundary
and splicing requirements may be necessary. With the trend toward nonlinear static
analysis (pushover) procedures, as called for in performance-based structural
engineering guidelines [FEMA-273, 1997 and ATC-40, 1996], the ability to use
plastic analyses will become increasingly important. The first three chapters of the
textbook Plastic Design in Steel [ASCE, 1971] summarize the basic principles and
methods of plastic design, and these are recommended reading for the interested
reader.
Given below is an illustration of plastic analysis for the reinforced concrete walls
and coupling beams of this Design Example.
5a.
249
Design Example 5
a.
b.
c.
d.
Design Example 5
Table 5-4. Approximate probable moment strengths of wall piers for plastic analysis
5b.
Level
Grid Line
Reinforcement of
Column Portion
4th
4th
1st
1st
1st
4th
4th
C
D
C
D
E
C
D
8-#9
8-#10
8-#9
8-#9
8-#9
8-#11
8-#11
630
630
1,300
1,400
1,200
630
630
M pr (k-ft)
10,500
7,500
12,500
28,000
10,000
13,000
8,000
The preferred behavior of the wall occurs when plastic hinges occur at the base of
the wall piers and in the coupling beams. This produces the desirable situation of
flexural yielding, energy dissipation, and avoidance of shear failures.
Table 5-5 shows calculations of the shear strength of the preferred plastic
mechanism, which has plastic hinges forming at the base of each wall pier and in
each coupling beam. The equivalent plastic hinge length at the pier base, lp, is
taken equal to 5 feet.
The plastic hinge length is used in the calculation of external work shown in
Table 5-5. The calculation is not sensitive to the value of lp assumed, since lp /2 is
subtracted from hi, the height above the base. In this case, the value of 5 feet is
taken as one-half the wall length of the external wall piers. Although the central
pier is longer, it is assigned the same plastic hinge length. Note that in the strain
calculation procedure for wall boundary design, the value used for lp has a
significant effect on the results. This is discussed in Part 7 of Design Example 4.
Plastic lateral story displacements, i , increase linearly with height above the
midpoint of the base plastic hinges. i is arbitrarily set equal to 1.00 feet at the
roof. The external work equals the sum of each lateral story force, fxi, times i .
251
Design Example 5
The plastic rotation angle of the wall piers, , equals the roof displacement
divided by the roof height above the midpoint of the plastic hinge. Thus,
= 1.00 85.5 . The plastic rotation angle and internal work of the coupling beams
can be calculated as follows:
cb =
lc
ln
where:
l n = clear length of the coupling beam
lc = distance between centroids of wall pier sections
Internal work
The internal work of the base plastic hinges equals the sum of Mpr times for each
of the three base plastic hinges. The summation of the internal work is shown in
Table 5-5. Equating internal work with external work gives the solution of
V = 2,420 kips .
252
Design Example 5
hi
(ft)
hi l p 2
(ft)
i
(ft)
fxi
V
Work / V
(ft)
88
74
60
46
32
18
85.5
71.5
57.5
43.5
29.5
15.5
1.000
0.836
0.673
0.509
0.345
0.181
0.254
0.240
0.195
0.149
0.104
0.058
1.000
0.254
0.201
0.131
0.076
0.036
0.011
0.708
Work
(k-ft)
Level
1.25Vn
(k)
lc
(ft)
C-D
C-D
C-D
C-D
C-D
C-D
D-E
D-E
D-E
R
6th
5th
4th
3rd
2nd
4th
3rd
2nd
291
468
671
368
368
480
528
671
609
21.5
21.5
21.5
21.5
21.5
21.5
21.5
21.5
21.5
= 1.00/85.5
Level
C
D
E
base
base
base
73
118
169
93
93
121
133
169
153
1,120
M pr
(k-ft)
Work
(k-ft)
12500
28000
10000
146
327
117
591
Note:
1. See Figure 5-10 for illustration of hinge locations.
253
Design Example 5
5c.
th
Table 5-6 shows calculations of the shear strength of another possible plastic
mechanism, which has plastic hinges forming at the 4th floor wall piers and only in
the coupling beams at the 5th, 6th, and roof levels. This plastic mechanism is less
desirable than a mechanism with hinging at the base, because energy dissipation is
concentrated in fewer yielding locations, and because plastic rotations in the wall
piers would need to be much greater to achieve the same roof displacement.
As in the previous calculation, plastic lateral story displacements, i , increase
linearly with height above the midpoint of the base plastic hinges, and i is set
equal to 1.00 feet at the roof. For this mechanism, the plastic rotation angle of the
wall piers, , equals 1.00/39.5. The plastic analysis solution, based on equating
internal and external work, gives V = 2,300 kips . Since this is less than 2,420 kips,
the mechanism having plastic hinging at the 4th floor governs (i.e., is more likely to
form than the preferred base mechanism shown in Figure 5-10).
To help prevent plastic hinging in the 4th floor piers, their flexural strength can be
increased. Reinforcement of the column portions of these wall piers is increased to
8-#11. Table 5-6 shows revised internal work calculations. The solution gives
V = 2,460 kips . Since this is greater than 2420 kips, the preferred mechanism now
governs.
Note that the calculation of the governing plastic limit load, V, depends on the
assumed vertical distribution of lateral forces, which in actual seismic response can
vary significantly from the inverted triangular pattern assumed. Thus the difference
between V = 2,420 kips and 2,460 kips does not absolutely ensure against plastic
hinging in the 4th floor wall piers.
254
Design Example 5
hi
(ft)
hi l p 2
(ft)
i
(ft)
fxi
V
Work / V
(ft)
42
28
14
39.5
25.5
11.5
1.000
0.646
0.291
0.000
0.000
0.000
0.254
0.240
0.195
0.149
0.104
0.058
1.000
0.254
0.155
0.057
0.000
0.000
0.000
0.466
Level
1.25Vn
(k)
lc
(ft)
Work
(k-ft)
C-D
C-D
C-D
Sum
R
6th
5th
291
468
671
17
17
17
125
201
289
615
= 1.00/39.5
Level
C
D
Sum
4th
4th
M pr
(k-ft)
Work
(k-ft)
10500
7500
266
190
456
Note:
1. See Figure 5-11 for illustration of hinge locations.
255
Design Example 5
Level
C
D
Sum
4th
4th
M pr
(k-ft)
13000
8000
Work
(k-ft)
329
203
532
th
6.
In this part, the wall piers will be designed for shear. Both the UBC and Blue Book
approaches will be illustrated. Design for the minimum UBC requirements is given
in Part 6a below.
As discussed in Part 5 of Design Example 4, the SEAOC Blue Book contains more
restrictive requirements than does the UBC for the shear design of reinforced
concrete walls. The SEAOC approach, in Part 6b of this Design Example, is
recommended for the reasons given in Design Example 4.
256
Design Example 5
6a.
If designing to the minimum requirements of the UBC, the shear demand is taken
directly from the design forces, factored by the load combinations discussed in
Part 1. For the example wall, all of the significant shear on the wall piers results
from earthquake forces, thus Vu = VE , where the values VE are those shown in
Figure 5-3. The highest shears are at the 4th floor, Line D, with VE = 544 kips in an
11-foot-long wall pier (48.5 k/ft), and at the 1st floor, Line D, with VE = 731kips in
a 20-foot long wall pier (36.6 k/ft).
Shear capacity.
1921.6.5
UBC 1911.10 gives shear provisions for walls designed for nonseismic lateral
forces such as wind or earth pressure. Section 1921.6.5 gives shear strength
provisions for walls designed for seismic forces.
In Equation (21-7), wall shear strength depends on c , which depends on the ratio
hw l w .
Vn = Acv c
f 'c + n f y
(21-7)
Per 1921.6.5.4 the ratio hw l w is taken as the larger of that for the individual wall
pier and for the entire wall.
Overall wall
hw l w = 88' 54'
= 1.63
hw l w = 8' 11'
= 0.73
hw l w = 8' 20'
= 0.40
Thus the value hw l w = 1.63 governs for all wall piers. The coefficient c varies
linearly from 3.0 for hw l w = 1.5 to 2.0 for hw l w = 2.0 .
c = 3.0 1.0(1.63 1.5) (2.0 1.5) = 2.74
257
Design Example 5
Grid
Line
lw
(in.)
VE
(kips)
Horizontal
Reinforcement
Vn
(kips)
4th
4th
1st
1st
1st
C
D
C
D
E
132
132
132
240
132
371
544
283
731
316
#4@10 E.F.
#6@10 E.F.
#4@10 E.F.
#4@10 E.F.
#4@10 E.F.
0.00250
0.00550
0.00250
0.00250
0.00250
409
637
409
744
409
Vu Acv f 'c
(1)
4.63
6.79
3.53
5.02
3.95
Note:
1. Under 1921.6.5.6, the value of Vu Acv
for an entire wall section.
As shown above, for all wall pier locations except the 4th floor at Line D, the
minimum reinforcement ratio of 0.0025 (required under 1921.6.2.1) is sufficient
to meet UBC shear strength requirements.
6b.
To comply with the Blue Book requirement of providing shear strength in excess
of the shear corresponding to wall flexural strength, an amplified shear demand
must be considered. For this Design Example, shear strength in excess of that
corresponding to the development of probable flexural strength will be provided.
This has been calculated by the plastic analysis in Part 5 of this Design Example as
V = 2,420 kips at the base of the wall.
Section C402.8 of the Blue Book Commentary gives the following equation for the
shear amplification factor, v , that accounts for inelastic dynamic effects. For
application to designs according to the UBC, the amplification factor
recommended by Paulay and Priestley [1992] can be reduced by a factor of 0.85,
because the Paulay and Priestley recommendations use a different strength
reduction factor, , than does the UBC.
258
Design Example 5
As indicated in the Blue Book, the v factor is derived for analysis using inverted
triangular distributions of lateral forces. If a response spectrum analysis is carried
out, a slightly lower v factor can be justified in some cases.
At the base of the wall, the magnified shear demand Vu * is calculated as follows:
Since we are designing for the nominal shear strength to exceed the shear
corresponding to flexural strength, a strength reduction factor, , of 0.85 can be
used. As before, UBC Equation (21-6) is used to calculate shear capacity:
Vn = Acv c
f 'c + n f y
(21-7)
o.k.
For the other stories of the building, the shear demands are magnified from the
analysis results by the same proportion as for the first floor. The recommended
amount of horizontal reinforcement can be calculated as shown in the Table 5-9.
259
Design Example 5
VE (kips)
338
656
915
1,150
1,250
1,310
Vu * (kips) (1)
l w net (in.)
Horizontal
Reinforcement
Vn (kips)
264
264
264
504
504
504
#5@12 E.F.
#6@12 E.F.
#6@8 E.F.
#6@12 E.F.
#6@12 E.F.
#6@12 E.F.
0.00323
0.00458
0.00688
0.00458
0.00458
0.00458
1,320
1,610
2,100
3,070
3,070
3,070
788
1,530
2,130
2,680
2,920
3,100
Note:
1. Vu * = magnified shear demand.
At the 4th floor wall piers, the vertical reinforcement must be increased from
#7@12" to #8@12" to provide v n , per 1921.6.55.5. The Blue Book deletes
this requirement for the reasons given in Blue Book C402.9. However, in this
case, the increase in flexural strength of the 4th floor wall piers is desirable, as
discussed in Part 5C, above.
6c.
A comparison of the Tables 5-8 and 5-9 shows that the Blue Book
recommendations for ensuring that shear strength exceeds flexural capacity results
in increased horizontal reinforcement compared to that required by the UBC. The
Blue Book approach is recommended, as it leads to more ductile wall behavior.
7.
The UBC gives two alternatives for determining whether or not boundary zone
detailing needs to be provided: a simplified procedure (1921.6.6.4), and a strain
calculation procedure (1921.6.6.5). For this Design Example, the simplified
procedure will be used, and for comparison the Blue Book recommendations for
the strain calculation procedure will be checked. For an illustration of the UBC
strain calculation procedure, see Design Example 4.
260
Design Example 5
7a.
1921.6.6.4
and either
M
(Vu l w ) 1.0
or
Vu 3 Acv
f 'c
For the critical piers of the example wall, Pu /Agfc calculated as shown in
Table 5-10. All of the piers are geometrically unsymmetrical, except for those on
Line D at the 1st, 2nd, and 3rd stories. Of the unsymmetrical piers, only those at the
6th floor have Pu Ag f ' c 0.005 and Vu 3 Acv f ' c . All three of the symmetrical
piers have Pu / Ag f c 0.01 and Vu 3 Acv
boundary confinement except those at the 6 floor, and those on Line D at the 1st,
2nd, and 3rd floors.
The required boundary zone length is calculated as a function of Pu / Ag f c per
1921.6.6.4. The code requires that shear walls and portions of shear walls not
meeting the conditions of 1921.6.6.4 and having Pu < 0.35Po shall have boundary
zones at each end over a distance that varies linearly from 0.25l w to 0.15l w as Pu
varies from 0.35Po to 0.15Po . The boundary zone shall have a minimum length of
0.15l w and shall be detailed in accordance with 1921.6.6.6. The results of this
determination are shown in Table 5-10.
Table 5-10. Boundary zone strength requirement by the UBC simplified procedure
Level
Line
6th
4th
1st
1st
1st
C,D
D
C
E
D
Pu
(in.2)
Pu
Ag f 'c
(Required Boundary
Length) lw
Required
Boundary Length (in.)
2,300
2,300
2,300
2,300
4,030
0.042
0.182
0.342
0.284
0.078
not required
0.166
0.246
0.217
not required
not required
21.9
32.5
28.6
not required
Ag
261
Design Example 5
At the column end of each wall pier, confining the 8 column bars plus two wallweb bars gives a boundary zone length of 34 inches. At the inside (doorway) end of
each wall pier, confining 8 bars give a boundary zone length of 39 inches. The
confinement details are shown in Figure 5-12. The required area of boundary ties is
calculated according to Equation (21-10):
Ash = 0.09 shc f ' c f y
(21-10)
Table 5-11. Required boundary zone ties by the UBC simplified procedure
Section Cut
hc
(in.)
s
(in.)
Ash Required
(in.2)
Tie legs
Ash Provided
(in.2)
A
B
C
D
E
20.5
12.5
32
12.5
37.5
6
6
6
4
4
0.74
0.45
1.12
0.45
0.90
3-#5
2-#5
4-#5
2-#5
4-#5
0.93
0.62
1.24
0.62
1.24
Note:
1. See Figure 5-12.
262
Design Example 5
7b.
SEAOC 402.11
Section 402.11 of the Blue Book contains significant revisions to the UBC
provisions for wall boundary confinement. Sections 402.11.1 and 402.11.2 revise
definitions used in the strain calculation procedure of 1921.6.6.5. Blue Book
402.11.3 adds the following two exceptions to the UBC procedure:
Exception 1: Boundary zone details need not be provided where the
neutral axis depth c'u is less than 0.15l w .
Exception 2: The length of wall section at the compression boundary
over which boundary zone detailing is to be provided may be taken as
cc , where cc is the larger of c'u = 0.1lw or c'u 2 .
In applying these recommendations to the example wall, the wall piers with the
largest neutral axis depth-to-length ratio, cu /lw, govern the design. The largest
neutral axis depth at the column end of a wall pier occurs at the 1st floor at Line C,
where a large downward earthquake axial force occurs:
Pu = (1.2PD + 0.5PL) + PE = 1,300 kips + 1,600 kips = 2,900 kips
The neutral axis depth, cu, for this case is calculated by PCACOL to be 48 inches.
c'u l w = 48" 132" = 0.36 0.15 therefore boundary zone detailing is required
cc = c'u 0.1l w = 48"0.1(132") = 35 in.
cc = c'u 2 = 48" 2 = 24 in.
governs
263
Design Example 5
Thus, the requirement for boundary confinement at the inside (doorway) ends of
the wall piers is marginal.
cc = c'u 0.1lw = 20"0.1(132") = 7 in.
cc = c'u 2 = 20" 2 = 10 in.
governs
8.
8a.
Layering of reinforcement.
264
Design Example 5
8b.
1921.4.4
)([ Ag
) ]
Ach 1
(21-3)
(21-4)
265
Design Example 5
The quantity Ag is calculated assuming the minimum cover per 1907.7 around
each diagonal bar core. For walls with No. 11 bars and smaller, without exposure
to weather, this minimum cover equals inch. Thus:
Ag = [9.0 + 2 (0.75)] [14.8 + 2 (0.75)] = 10.5 16.3 = 171 in. and
Ach = 9.0 14.8 = 133 in.
Although Ach is based on outside-to-outside of tie dimensions, hc is based on
center-to-center of tie dimensions. Assuming No. 4 ties, hc = 9.0 0.5 = 8.5 inches
in the horizontal direction, and hc = 14.8 0.5 = 14.3 inches in the other lateral
dimension. For hc = 8.5:
)[(Ag
) ]
Ach 1
(21-3)
governs
(21-4)
For hc = 14.3 :
)[(Ag / Ach ) 1]
(21-3)
governs
(21-4)
A single #4 tie around the six diagonal bars provides two tie legs in each direction
and Ash = 0.40 in .2 A #3 perimeter tie with a #3 crosstie would provide
Ash = 0.22 in .2 across the shorter core direction and Ash = 0.33 in .2 across the
longer core direction, which would not quite meet the Ash requirement of 0.343
in.2
Per 1921.4.4.3, crossties shall not be spaced more than 14 inches on center. For
the heaviest diagonal reinforcement of 6-#10 bars, the center-to-center dimension
of the #10 bars is given as 12 inches in Figure 5-14. The center-to-center hoop
dimension in this direction thus equals 12 inches plus one diameter of a #10 bar
plus one diameter of a #4 tie, equal to 12.0 + 1.27 + 0.5 = 13.8 inches. Since this is
less than 14 inches, a crosstie is not needed.
266
Design Example 5
The diagonal bars must be developed for tension into the wall piers. Following the
recommendation of Paulay and Priestley [1992], the bars are extended a distance of
1.5l d beyond the face of the supporting wall pier, as shown in Figure 5-14, where
l d is the development length of a straight bar as determined under 1912.2.
Crossties are added at the intersection of the diagonal bars at the center of the
coupling beam, and along their development into the wall piers, as shown in
Figure 5-14. The crossties are also added in locations where ties around the
diagonal bars are not used.
8c.
1921.6.10.4
267
Design Example 5
UBC requirements.
o.k.
o.k.
By 1910.5.1:
As , min = 200 bwd f y = 200 (16")(0.8 72") 60,000 psi = 3.07 in .2
(10-3)
This requires 7-#6 longitudinal bars (As = 7(0.44 in.2) = 3.08 in.2 ) both top and
bottom of the coupling beam, or 14-#6 longitudinal bars total. Per the discussion
below, these are not recommended by SEAOC to be used, and are not shown in
Figure 5-14.
Blue Book recommendations.
268
Design Example 5
References
ASCE, 1971, Plastic Design in Steel, A Guide and Commentary, American Society of
Civil Engineers, New York.
ATC-40, 1996. Seismic Evaluation and Retrofit of Concrete Buildings, Applied
Technology Council, Redwood City, California.
FEMA 273, 1997. NEHRP Guidelines for the Seismic Rehabilitation of Buildings,
Federal Emergency Management Agency, Washington, D.C.
FEMA 306/307, 1998. Evaluation of Earthquake Damaged Concrete and Masonry
Wall Buildings, Federal Emergency Management Agency, Washington, D.C.
Ghosh, S. K., 1998. Design of Reinforced Concrete Buildings under the 1997
UBC, Building Standards, May-June, pp. 20-24. International Conference of
Building Officials, Washington, D.C.
Maffei, J., 1996. Reinforced Concrete Structural Walls: Beyond the Code
SEAONC 1996 Fall Seminar Notes, Structural Engineers of Northern
California, San Francisco, California.
Paulay, T., and Priestley, M.J.N., 1992. Reinforced Concrete and Masonry Buildings,
Design for Seismic Resistance, John Wiley & Sons, New York, N.Y.
PCA, 1999. PCACOL: Design and Investigation of Reinforced Concrete Column
Sections, Portland Cement Association, Skokie, Illinois.
269
Design Example 5
270
Design Example 6
Design Example 6
Concrete Special Moment Resisting Frame
Figure 6-1. Seven-story concrete special moment resisting frame (SMRF) building
Overview
Concrete frame buildings, especially older, nonductile frames, have frequently
experienced significant structural damage in earthquakes and a number have
collapsed. Following the 1971 San Fernando earthquake, special requirements for
ductile concrete frames were introduced in the code. Today these ductile frames are
designated as special moment resisting frames (SMRF). All reinforced concrete
frame structures built in Seismic Zones 3 and 4 must be SMRF, as required by
1633.2.7. Ordinary moment resisting frames (OMRF) and intermediate moment
resisting frames (IMRF) are prohibited in Zones 3 and 4, except that IMRF are
permitted for some nonbuilding structures under 1634.2.
271
Design Example 6
Outline
This Design Example illustrates the following parts of the design process.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Beam design.
6.
Column design.
7.
8.
9.
Foundation considerations.
Given Information
The building has a floor system that consists of post-tensioned slabs and girders.
Vertical loads are carried by a frame system. Use of perimeter SMRF frames and
interior frames is designed to allow freedom for tenant improvements.
Seismic and site data:
Z = 0.4 (Seismic Zone 4)
I = 1.0 (standard occupancy)
Seismic source type = A
Distance to seismic source = 10 km
Soil profile type = S D
272
Table 16-I
Table 16-K
Design Example 6
9.0 psf
100.0
27.0
4.0
5.0
5.0
5.0
3.0
158.0 psf
(3rd-7th floors)
2.0 psf
100.0
48.0
8.0
10.0
10.0
5.0
3.0
186.0 psf
(2nd floor)
2.0 psf
100.0
48.0
10.0
10.0
10.0
5.0
3.0
188.0 psf
*Partitions are 2 psf for gravity calculations and 10 psf for seismic calculations.
Structural materials:
Concrete f c ' = 4,000 psi (regular weight)
Reinforcing A706, Grade 60 f y = 60 ksi
273
Design Example 6
274
Design Example 6
1.
Code Reference
Two key design parameters, the design base shear coefficient and the
reliability/redundancy factor , are determined in this part. The 1997 UBC
significantly revised the determination of base shear and introduced the concept of
the reliability/redundancy factor to penalize lateral force resisting systems that have
little redundancy. Base shear is now determined on a strength basis, whereas base
shear in the 1994 UBC was determined on an allowable stress basis, with forces
subsequently increased by load factors for concrete strength design. The 1997 UBC
also introduced design for vertical components of ground motion E v .
Period using Method A.
T = Ct (hn )3 / 4 = .030(86 )3 / 4 = .85 sec
(30-8)
Near source factors for seismic source type A and distance to source = 10 km
N a = 1.0
Table 16-S
N v = 1.2
Table 16-T
Seismic coefficients for Seismic Zone 4 (0.4) and soil profile type S D :
C a = 0.44 N a = 0.44(1.0 ) = 0.44
Table 16-Q
Table 16-R
The R coefficient for a reinforced concrete building with an SMRF system is:
R = 8.5
Table 16-N
Note that Table 16-N puts no limitation on building height when a SMRF system is
used.
275
Design Example 6
1a.
1630.2.2
Cv I
0.77(1.0 )
W=
W = 0.107W
RT
8.5(0.85)
(30-4)
2.5C a I
2.5(.44 )(1.0)
W =
W = 0.129W
R
8.5
(30-5)
(30-6)
In addition, for Seismic Zone 4, the total base shear shall also not be less than:
V =
0.8ZN v I
0.8(.4)(1.20 )(1.0 )
W =
W = 0.045W
R
8.5
(30-7)
1b.
1630.1
276
Design Example 6
Column base shear reactions from computer model of the building are shown
below (Figure 6-4). These base shear reactions are based on a computer analysis of
the frame as described later, including an accidental torsion moment.
116 k
176 k
168 k
176 k
116 k
Figure 6-4. Column shears at frame base (from computer analysis with 1.0Eh )
The maximum element story-shear ratio rmax is defined as the largest individual
element story-shear ratios at or below the two-thirds height of the building. For this
building rmax is calculated as shown below.
Calculation of r at interior SMRF bay:
r=
1630.1.1
0.70(176 k + 168 k )
= 0.16
1,475 k
Note that r should be evaluated at all moment frame bays and for the bottom twothirds levels of the building. Since no other r values control, other calculations are
not shown.
Equation (30-3) is used to calculate as shown below.
AB = (120')(90') = 10,800 ft 2
= 2
20
rmax AB
= 2
20
.16 10800
= 0.82 1.0
(30-3)
= 1.0
277
Design Example 6
For moment resisting SMRF frames, must be less than 1.25. If is greater than
1.25, additional bays must be added such that is less than or equal to 1.25.
1c.
1630.1.1
Because the design of the concrete frames will use strength design, the vertical
component E v must be considered in the load combination of Equation (30-1).
Determination of E v is shown below.
E v = 0.5C a ID = 0.5(0.44 )(1.0 )W = 0.22W
The effect of E v is added to the gravity loads that are used in combination with
horizontal seismic loads.
Thus, the following earthquake load is used in the earthquake load combinations:
E = E h + E v
2.
(30-1)
In this part, the seismic forces on the concrete frame are determined.
2a.
278
Level
Area
(sf)
wi
(psf)
WI
(kips)
R
7
6
5
4
3
2
10,800
10,800
10,800
10,800
10,800
10,800
10,800
158.0
186.0
186.0
186.0
186.0
186.0
188.0
1,706
2,009
2,009
2,009
2,009
2,009
2,030
Total
75,600
13,781
Design Example 6
2b.
(30-14)
V = Ft + Fi
(30-13)
i =1
The calculation of story forces and story shears is shown in Table 6-2 below.
W i
(k)
hi
(ft)
Story
H
(ft)
Wi h i
(k-ft)
Wi h i
W i h i
(%)
Ft =
R
7
6
5
4
3
2
1,706
2,009
2,009
2,009
2,009
2,009
2,030
1,706
3,715
5,724
7,733
9,742
11,750
13,781
86
74
62
50
38
26
14
12
12
12
12
12
12
14
146,750
148,651
124,546
100,440
76,334
52,229
28,426
Totals
13,781
677,376
Level
Fi
(k)
Fi
(k)
22%
22%
18%
15%
11%
8%
4%
87
301
30
255
206
156
107
58
388
304
255
206
544
651
709
100%
1,475
279
Design Example 6
3.
The longitudinal frame along Line A is designed in this part. First, dead and live
loads on the beams are determined using a tributary width of 15 feet. The gravity
loads applied to the beams in the frame analysis are summarized below in
Table 6-3.
Dead Load
(plf)
Live Load
(plf)
Roof
Floor
6th Floor
5th Floor
4th Floor
3rd Floor
2nd Floor
2,250
2,886
2,886
2,886
2,886
2,886
2,879
300
750
750
750
750
750
750
7th
280
Design Example 6
Story
Forces
(kips)
R
7
6
5
4
3
2
388
304
255
206
156
107
58
Total
Long. Frame
End Column
Node Forces
(kips)
24.7
19.4
16.3
13.1
10.0
6.8
3.7
Long. Frame
Interior Col.
Node Forces
(kips)
49.5
38.8
32.5
26.2
19.9
13.6
7.4
Trans. Frame
End Column
Node Forces
(kips)
33.0
25.9
21.7
17.5
13.3
9.1
4.9
Trans. Frame
Interior Col.
Node Forces
(kips)
66.0
51.7
43.4
35.0
26.6
18.2
9.9
1,475
The loads shown in Table 6-4 add to 50 percent of the design base shear. To
account for torsion, a load factor of 1.02 was used in the frame analysis program.
This problem was solved on a two dimensional frame program. Any elastic finite
element analysis program could be used, including those with three dimensional
capability.
4.
Under 1630.10.2, story drifts are limited to 0.020 times story heights for drifts
corresponding to the maximum inelastic response displacement m for structures
with periods 0.7 seconds or greater. Under 1630.10.2
m = 0.7 R s
or:
m = 0.7(8.5) s = 5.95 s
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
281
Design Example 6
Total
Height
(ft)
Story
Height
(ft)
Allowable
s
(in.)
Sum
s
(in.)
Allowable
M
(in.)
Sum
M
(in.)
R
7
6
5
4
3
2
86
74
62
50
38
26
14
12
12
12
12
12
12
14
0.484
0.484
0.484
0.484
0.484
0.484
0.565
3.469
2.985
2.501
2.017
1.533
1.049
0.565
2.88
2.88
2.88
2.88
2.88
2.88
3.36
20.64
17.76
14.88
12.00
9.12
6.24
3.36
The frame analysis is thus performed using a standard frame analysis program.
Columns, beams, and grade beams were sized to meet allowable drift limits.
Member section properties were chosen to represent the cracked structure. In
accordance with 1910.11.1, 70 percent of the gross section properties are used for
columns and 35 percent of gross section properties are used for beams to estimate
the contribution of cracked sections on frame behavior.
Selected sections were 42 42 corner columns, 36 44 interior columns, 30x48
beams and 60 48 foundation grade beams. The designer must size a frame which
meets drift limitations and also meets strength criteria. For the design of this frame,
the controlling parameters are frame stiffness and strength of beams. Using the
member sizes chosen, frame analysis gives the lateral story displacements, given
below in Table 6-6. Note that the frame analysis gives s deflections, thus the
comparison is made using s deflections and that the factor is not used in the
deflection analysis.
282
Story
Total
Height
(ft)
Story
Height
(ft)
R
7
6
5
4
3
2
86
74
62
50
38
26
14
12
12
12
12
12
12
14
From Analysis
s
Story Drifts
(in.)
0.38
0.48
0.48
0.48
0.47
0.44
Maximum
Allowable
s
Story Drifts
(in.)
From
Analysis
s
(in.)
Maximum
Allowable
s
(in.)
0.48
0.48
0.48
0.48
0.48
0.48
0.56
3.18
2.80
2.34
1.82
1.34
0.87
0.43
3.47
2.98
2.50
2.02
1.53
1.05
0.57
Design Example 6
As shown in Table 6-6, story drifts are determined to be within allowable limits.
The iteration between frame stiffness and member strengths has resulted in a frame
design with conservative drifts. The designer must iterate between frame analysis
and member section design.
5.
5a.
Beam design.
Load combinations.
The next procedure is frame member design. Frame beams are designed to support
gravity loads and resist seismic forces. Beams are sized to limit frame drift and to
resist the corresponding moment with a nominal strength M n . The factor for
bending analysis is 0.90. The controlling load combinations are given in 1612.2.1
and are summarized below. Note that Exception 2 of 1612.2.1 requires the load
combinations to be multiplied by 1.1 as shown below.
1.1(1.2 D + 0.5 L + 1.0 E + 0.22 D ) = 1.58 D + 0.55 L + 1.1E
(12-5)
(12-6)
Note: The SEAOC Seismology Committee does not support the 1.1 factor for
concrete and masonry elements under seismic loads and the 1.1 factor is not
included in the 1999 SEAOC Blue Book. However, until ICBO makes a different
ruling, it is part of the 1997 UBC and is thus included in this Design Example.
5b.
The nominal beam strength is calculated using the following formulas and ignoring
compression steel for simplicity:
a
M n = As f y d M u
2
Note that historic practice has been to consider the frame beam to have a
rectangular section without consideration of the contribution of the adjacent slab
for both compression and tension stresses. That is still true for design under the
1997 UBC. The ACI-318-99 has included new provisions requiring that the
adjacent slab be included in consideration of the frame beam analysis. These
provisions will be required in the adoption of future codes.
The probable flexural strength, Mpr, is calculated per 1921.5.1.1 using 1.25 f y for
the reinforcing steel stress. Recalculating the beam strength using = 1.0 , thus:
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
283
Design Example 6
a pr
M pr = 1.25 As f y d
The shear strength of the beam must be designed to be greater than required in
order to resist Mpr, at both ends of the beam. L is the distance from column face to
column face. For this Design Example the distance is L = 30 ft 48 in. (columns)
= 26 ft 0 in. The factor for shear analysis is 0.85 per 1909.3.2.3. Thus, the
ultimate shear load is calculated as:
Vu=
+M
pr
( M
L
pr
w FACTORED , GRAVITY L
2
V n
V n = V c + V s
V c = 0;
Vs = .85 Av f
d
s
d 4.
2.
3.
4.
12 inches.
1921.3.3.2
An example beam design for Beam 36 (Figure 6-5) is shown. The controlling load
combinations, including seismic forces, are Equations (12-5) and (12-6).
Depending on the direction of seismic inertial force, seismic moments add with
gravity moments at one beam end and subtract at the other end.
Beyond regions of potential plastic hinges, stirrups with seismic ties are required at
a maximum spacing of d 2 throughout the length of the beam under 1921.3.3.4.
Diagrammatic shear and moment diagrams are shown below in Figure 6-6.
284
Design Example 6
Gravity loading
Gravity moment
Gravity shear
Seismic moment
Seismic shear
A review of the moment and shear diagrams for gravity loads and seismic loads
(Figure 6-6) will help the designer realize that seismic moment and negative
gravity moment at beam ends will be additive for top reinforcement design and
subtractive for bottom reinforcement design. Since seismic moment is usually
considerably greater than gravity moment, the reinforcement design will be
controlled by load combinations including seismic loads. However, greater
amounts of top reinforcement will be required than bottom reinforcement. Since
the frame behavior produces beam moments as depicted in Figure 6-6, load
combination Equation (12-5) will maximize negative moments for top
reinforcement design and load combination Equation (12-6) will maximize positive
moments for bottom reinforcement design.
285
Design Example 6
a=
200bwd 200(30")(45")
=
= 4.5 in.2 7.80 in.2
fy
60,000 psi
o.k.
4.59" 1 1 kip
From the frame analysis, Equation (12-6), positive moment is 905 k-ft.
Try 5-#9 bottom bars, As = 5.0 in.2
a=
2.94" 1 1 kip
o.k.
Thus, the Beam 36 design will have 5-#11 top bars and 5-#9 bottom bars. Note that
1921.3.2.2 requires that positive moment strength (bottom reinforcement) be a
minimum 50 percent of negative moment strength at the joints and that neither the
positive nor negative moment strength along the beam be less than one-quarter of
the strength at either joint (end).
286
Design Example 6
5c.
5d.
o.k.
As noted above, the beam will also have 5-#5 side bars on each side of the beam.
For this Design Example, the assumption is made that 3-#5 side bars each side
contribute to the plastic moment. For shear design, the designer allows for plastic
hinge formation that will produce shear forces greater than those from frame
analysis.
Vu=
+a =
+M
pr
(M
pr
wGRAVITY L
2
7.10"
7.10" 1
= 2,328 k - ft
+ M pr = (1.25) 7.80 in.2 (60,000 psi ) 45"
a pr =
5.04"
5.04" 1
= 1,647 k - ft
M pr = (1.25) 5.0 in.2 (60,000 psi ) 45"
+ (1.25) 1.86 in.2 (60,000 psi ) 30"
2
2 12,000
287
Design Example 6
Shear from dead load is calculated from the load combination of Equation (12-5):
26'
V gravity = [(1.58)(2,879 plf ) + (0.55)(750plf )]
= 65 kips
2
Vu =
The design shear Vu is thus the sum of the shear from the plastic end moments plus
the gravity shear.
Seismic stirrups at the plastic hinge regions are calculated as shown below. Note
that the plastic hinge region is a distance of 2h from the column face.
Try #4 ties with four vertical legs at 6-inch spacing over the 2h length (86 inches).
Vn = Vc + V s
Vc = 0
Vs =
Av f y d
s
Vn = 0 +
o.k.
Therefore, use 4 legs, #4 stirrup ties at 6-inch spacing at plastic hinge regions at
beam ends.
Seismic stirrups in the beam between plastic hinge regions are calculated as
follows.
Try #4 ties at 8-inch spacing:
13'3"2 45"
Vu = 181 kips + 65 kips
= 209 kips
13'3"
Vs = .85 .80 in.2 (60,000 psi )(45") 8" = 229 kips 209 kips
o.k.
288
Design Example 6
Therefore, the final design for Beam 36 is a 30-inch wide by 48-inch deep beam
with 5-#11 top bars, 5-#9 bottom bars, 5-#5 side bars, and 4 legs - #4 stirrup ties at
6-inch spacing each end with 4 legs - #4 stirrup ties at 8 feet between.
5e.
Following these same procedures and using the forces from the frame analysis, the
Frame A beam designs for flexural strength are shown in Table 6-7.
M u ,i
M u, j
b
d
h
(Eq. 12-6) (Eq. 12-5) (in.) (in.) (in.)
36
-1,405
905
37
-1,389
858
38
-1,392
856
39
-1,422
876
Level 3
40
-1,568
1,093
41
-1,569
1,036
42
-1,564
1,036
43
-1,637
1,036
Level 4
44
-1,281
781
45
-1,304
772
46
-1,304
772
47
-1,334
781
Bar
No.
Location bars
Bar
Size
Bar
Area
(in.2)
As
(in.2)
a
(in.)
M n Bending
DCR (1)
(k-ft) Results
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
48
48
48
48
48
48
48
48
45
45
45
45
45
45
45
45
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
#11
#9
#11
#9
#11
#9
#11
#9
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
1,499
979
1,499
979
1,499
979
1,499
979
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
0.94
0.92
0.93
0.88
0.93
0.87
0.95
0.89
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
52
52
52
52
52
52
52
52
49
49
49
49
49
49
49
49
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
#11
#9
#11
#9
#11
#9
#11
#9
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
1,639
1,069
1,639
1,069
1,639
1,069
1,639
1,069
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
0.96
1.02
0.96
0.97
0.95
0.97
1.00
0.97
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
44
44
44
44
44
44
44
44
41
41
41
41
41
41
41
41
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
#11
#9
#11
#9
#11
#9
#11
#9
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
1,359
889
1,359
889
1,359
889
1,359
889
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
0.94
0.88
0.96
0.87
0.96
0.87
0.98
0.88
289
Design Example 6
-1,273
783
49
-1,298
766
50
-1,297
766
51
-1,343
780
Level 6
52
-854
337
53
-878
346
54
-878
346
55
-887
346
Level 7
56
-775
257
57
-799
267
58
-799
266
59
-806
266
Roof
40
-593
206
41
-603
198
42
-599
196
43
-610
199
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
44
44
44
44
44
44
44
44
41
41
41
41
41
41
41
41
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
#11
#9
#11
#9
#11
#9
#11
#9
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
1.56
1.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
7.80
5.00
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
4.59
2.94
1,359
889
1,359
889
1,359
889
1,359
889
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
0.94
0.88
0.96
0.86
0.95
0.86
0.99
0.88
24
24
24
24
24
24
24
24
36
36
36
36
36
36
36
36
33
33
33
33
33
33
33
33
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
#11
#8
#11
#8
#11
#8
#11
#8
1.56
0.79
1.56
0.79
1.56
0.79
1.56
0.79
6.24
3.16
6.24
3.16
6.24
3.16
6.24
3.16
4.59
2.32
4.59
2.32
4.59
2.32
4.59
2.32
862
453
862
453
862
453
862
453
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
0.99
0.74
1.00
0.76
1.00
0.76
1.00
0.76
24
24
24
24
24
24
24
24
36
36
36
36
36
36
36
36
33
33
33
33
33
33
33
33
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
#11
#8
#11
#8
#11
#8
#11
#8
1.56
0.79
1.56
0.79
1.56
0.79
1.56
0.79
6.24
3.16
6.24
3.16
6.24
3.16
6.24
3.16
4.59
2.32
4.59
2.32
4.59
2.32
4.59
2.32
862
453
862
453
862
453
862
453
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
0.90
0.57
0.93
0.59
0.93
0.59
0.93
0.59
24
24
24
24
24
24
24
24
36
36
36
36
36
36
36
36
33
33
33
33
33
33
33
33
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
#10
#8
#10
#8
#10
#8
#10
#8
1.27
0.79
1.27
0.79
1.27
0.79
1.27
0.79
5.08
3.16
5.08
3.16
5.08
3.16
5.08
3.16
3.74
2.32
3.74
2.32
3.74
2.32
3.74
2.32
712
453
712
453
712
453
712
453
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
o.k.
0.83
0.46
0.85
0.44
0.84
0.43
0.86
0.44
Note:
1. DCR=demand to capacity ratio
290
Design Example 6
(k-ft)
V s Vn
s
Result DCR (1)
(in.) (kips) (kips)
7.10
5.04
7.10
5.04
7.10
5.04
7.10
5.04
2,389
1,708
2,389
1,708
2,389
1,708
2,389
1,708
215
154
215
154
215
154
215
154
70
285
0.0
0.80
6.0
306
306
o.k.
0.93
70
285
0.0
0.80
6.0
306
306
o.k.
0.93
70
285
0.0
0.80
6.0
306
306
o.k.
0.93
70
285
0.0
0.80
6.0
306
306
o.k.
0.93
2.64
2.64
2.64
2.64
2.64
2.64
2.64
2.64
7.68
5.62
7.68
5.62
7.68
5.62
7.68
5.62
2,769
2,028
2,769
2,028
2,769
2,028
2,769
2,028
253
185
253
185
253
185
253
185
70
323
0.0
0.80
6.0
333
333
o.k.
0.97
70
323
0.0
0.80
6.0
333
333
o.k.
0.97
70
323
0.0
0.80
6.0
333
333
o.k.
0.97
70
323
0.0
0.80
6.0
333
333
o.k.
0.97
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
1.20
1.20
1.20
1.20
1.20
1.20
1.20
1.20
6.62
4.56
6.62
4.56
6.62
4.56
6.62
4.56
2,055
1,435
2,055
1,435
2,055
1,435
2,055
1,435
182
127
182
127
182
127
182
127
70
252
0.0
0.80
6.0
279
279
o.k.
0.90
70
252
0.0
0.80
6.0
279
279
o.k.
0.90
70
252
0.0
0.80
6.0
279
279
o.k.
0.90
70
252
0.0
0.80
6.0
279
279
o.k.
0.90
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
1.20
1.20
1.20
1.20
1.20
1.20
1.20
1.20
6.62
4.56
6.62
4.56
6.62
4.56
6.62
4.56
2,055
1,435
2,055
1,435
2,055
1,435
2,055
1,435
182
127
182
127
182
127
182
127
70
252
0.0
0.80
6.0
279
279
o.k.
0.90
70
252
0.0
0.80
6.0
279
279
o.k.
0.90
70
252
0.0
0.80
6.0
279
279
o.k.
0.90
70
252
0.0
0.80
6.0
279
279
o.k.
0.90
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
4-#11
4-#8
4-#11
4-#8
4-#11
4-#8
4-#11
4-#8
5.74
2.90
5.74
2.90
5.74
2.90
5.74
2.90
1,175
623
1,175
623
1,175
623
1,175
623
101
54
101
54
101
54
101
54
70
171
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.76
70
171
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.76
70
171
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.76
70
171
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.76
Bar
Loc.
As
T&B
As
side
a
(in.2)
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
1.86
1.86
1.86
1.86
1.86
1.86
1.86
1.86
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
5-#11
5-#9
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
Top
Bottom
M pr
291
Design Example 6
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
4-#11
4-#8
4-#11
4-#8
4-#11
4-#8
4-#11
4-#8
5.74
2.90
5.74
2.90
5.74
2.90
5.74
2.90
1,175
623
1,175
623
1,175
623
1,175
623
101
54
101
54
101
54
101
54
70
171
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.76
70
171
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.76
70
171
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.76
70
171
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.76
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
Top
4-#10
4-#8
4-#10
4-#8
4-#10
4-#8
4-#10
4-#8
4.67
2.90
4.67
2.90
4.67
2.90
4.67
2.90
974
623
974
623
974
623
974
623
84
54
84
54
84
54
84
54
48
132
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.59
48
132
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.59
48
132
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.59
48
132
0.0
0.80
6.0
224
224
o.k.
0.59
Note:
1. DCR=demand to capacity ratio.
Therefore, use 5-#5 bars Ask = 1.55 in.2 / 1.44 in.2 each side spaced
d 6 = 45 in. / 6 = 7.5 in. along the side face of the beam.
Having satisfied both the design for bending and shear, the final beam designs are
thus chosen as shown in Table 6-9. See Figure 6-7 for a beam cross-section
showing dimensions and reinforcement.
292
Design Example 6
Width
(in.)
Depth
(in.)
Long. Reinf.
Top
Long. Reinf.
Bottom
Skin
Reinf.
Roof
24
36
4-#10
4-#6
None
24
36
4-#11
4-#7
None
24
36
4-#11
4-#7
None
30
42
5-#11
5-#9
30
42
5-#11
5-#9
30
52
5-#11
5-#9
30
48
5-#11
5-#9
5 - #4
ea. face
5 - #5
ea. face
5 - #6
ea. face
5 - #5
ea. face
Shear Reinf.
In Hinge
Regions
Shear Reinf.
Between
Hinge Regions
4 legs
#4 ties@ 6"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 6"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 6"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 6"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 6"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 6"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 6"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 12
4 legs
#4 ties@ 9"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 9"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 8"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 8"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 6"
4 legs
#4 ties@ 6
293
Design Example 6
6.
Column design.
Columns should be designed to ensure that the plastic hinges are located in the
beams (i.e., strong column-weak beam behavior) and to resist column shears. To
ensure strong column-weak beam behavior, columns must be designed to have
nominal bending strengths 120 percent stronger than beams per 1921.4.2.2. This
is achieved by summing the M e of columns above and below a joint and
comparing that with the sum of M g for beams on both sides of a joint.
M e (6 / 5) M g
(21-1)
The controlling girder location occurs at Level 3. The girder is a 30 in. by 52 in.
with 5-#11s top, 5-#9s bottom, and 5-#6s shin reinforcement each side. The
assumed two skin bars are effective in calculation of M g , or alternatively a
computer program can be used for more accurate results.
Calculation of M g (negative, at beam tops).
a=
5.62"
5.62"
2
M g = (0.90 ) 7.80 in.2 (60,000 psi ) 49"
+ (0.90 ) 1.76 in. (60,000 psi ) 37.5"
2
2
a=
3.98"
3.98"
2
M g = (0.90 ) 5.00 in.2 (60,000 psi ) 49"
+ (0.90 ) 1.76 in. (60,000 psi ) 37.5"
2
2
294
Design Example 6
5
5
Therefore, at end columns:
6
6
M g = (1,896 kip-ft) = 2,275 kip-ft
5
5
The girder moments are resisted by two column sections, the column above the
joint and the column below the joint. The required column strengths, M e , for
interior and end columns are given below.
Me =
1
(3,882 kip-ft) = 1,941 kip-ft
2
Me =
1
(2,275 kip-ft) = 1,138 kip-ft
2
or:
6a.
For column design, the load combinations of Equations (12-5) and (12-6) are used.
Also, because strength design is used, the effect of the vertical seismic component
Ev must be included. Equations (12-5) and (12-6) are given below. Tables 6-10
and 6-11 provide axial forces and moments on the columns of Frame A for
Equations (12-5) and (12-6), respectively.
1.1(1.2 D + 0.5 L + 1.0 E + 0.22 D ) = 1.58 D + 0.55 L + 1.0 E h
(12-5)
(12-6)
295
Design Example 6
296
Pu
(kips)
145
141
148
136
123
81
34
1,001
850
700
553
405
258
111
1,002
853
705
557
408
260
112
990
843
698
552
406
259
111
868
724
566
428
290
181
78
Vu
(kips)
114
71
62
51
39
23
-21
192
196
180
158
128
88
62
185
196
181
160
130
93
61
195
195
185
162
132
94
61
140
137
127
115
103
90
55
M u bottom
(k-ft)
1,604
476
505
323
276
-69
-305
2,227
1,212
1,255
942
874
326
102
2,142
1,214
1,262
954
886
346
86
2,259
1,193
1,289
963
901
346
80
1,719
902
894
709
668
318
45
M u top
(k-ft)
-226
-374
-241
-287
-190
-347
-54
-842
-1142
-903
-957
-665
-733
-642
-822
-1133
-913
-969
-670
-770
-647
-868
-1141
-926
-983
-680
-783
-651
-520
-744
-625
-675
-570
-762
-610
Design Example 6
Pu
(kips)
Vu
(kips)
-140
-102
-53
-23
7
8
4
441
374
307
243
178
114
51
438
373
309
244
180
115
51
430
367
305
242
179
115
50
583
481
365
270
174
108
47
122
90
80
69
57
42
0
193
196
181
159
129
90
62
185
196
181
160
130
93
61
194
195
183
161
131
92
61
133
118
108
97
85
71
34
M u bottom
(k-ft)
1636
597
615
432
386
40
-206
2236
1206
1264
948
882
332
96
2142
1214
1262
954
886
346
86
2250
1198
1279
957
894
340
86
1686
782
784
600
557
209
-53
M u top
(k-ft)
-309
-478
-350
-397
-297
-464
-207
-849
-1142
-910
-964
-669
-747
-645
-822
-1133
-913
-969
-670
-770
-647
-860
-1141
-919
-976
-675
-769
-648
-437
-639
-517
-566
-462
-644
-458
297
Design Example 6
6b.
(10-1)
Note that = 0.70 for members with axial compression and flexure (not with
spiral shear reinforcement) per 1909.3.2.2.
Calculation of the balance point is determined by using 0.002 strain for reinforcing
steel at yield and 0.003 for concrete strain at crushing (1910.3.2.). By summing
forces and moments, the balanced axial load and moment (Pb , M b ) can be
determined. The nominal moment strength is determined by using 0.002 strain for
steel yielding and by calculating tension forces and compression forces such that
they add up to 0. The resulting moment is thus M n , where = 0.90 .
The equation for tension members is:
Tn = f y Ast
Note that = 0.90 for members with axial tension and axial tension with flexure
per 1909.3.2.2.
The designer may use a commercial program such as PCACOL developed by the
Portland Cement Association to develop a P M diagram for the column axial
load-moment interaction, including effects for slenderness of columns. From the
frame analysis for Frame A, the controlling load cases are summarized in
Table 6-12.
298
Design Example 6
Level
Location
Size
(in.)
Load
Comb.
Equation
Pu
(kips)
Vu
(kips)
Mu
(k-ft)
22
1
1
1
interior
end
36x44
42x42
12-5
12-6
990
-140
195
121
2,258
1,636
Pn (kips)
P-M diagram
column 22 point
Mn (kip-ft)
299
Design Example 6
Check 42 42 corner Column 1 with 20-#10 bars around perimeter. The resulting
P M diagram is shown in Figure 6-9.
Pn (kips)
P-M diagram
column 1 point
Mn (kip-ft)
By comparing the design loads against the column P M diagrams of Figures 6-8
and 6-9, it can be seen that both columns have adequate strength. Both column
sections achieve 120 percent of beam moment strength, and thus have adequate
strength to develop the plastic moments of beams. M n for interior columns is
approximately 2,550 kip-ft and for end columns is approximately 2,450 kip-ft at
the axial load of approximately 1,000 kips.
6
Me = 5 M
M e,interior
300
2(2,550 kip - ft )
= 7,284 kip-ft 3,882 kip-ft
0.7
o.k.
M e,end =
2(2,450 kip - ft )
= 7,000 kip-ft 2,275 kip-ft
0.7
o.k.
Design Example 6
It is assumed by the code that the design of columns to be 120 percent greater in
flexural strength than girders will ensure plastic hinge formation in the beams, and
this is probably true in most cases. Since that is what is required in the 1997 UBC,
that is what is shown in this Design Example.
Some engineers believe that they should design the columns to develop the strength
of the beam plastic moments Mpr. While this is not explicitly required by the 1997
UBC, it is probably a good idea. The reasoning is that the yielding elements in the
frame are the beam plastic moments located at beam ends followed by column
plastic moments at column bases. When all nonyielding aspects of the frame are
designed to be stronger than the yielding elements, the anticipated frame yield
behavior is ensured. Thus, the shear design of beams, columns, and joints, column
flexural strengths, and foundation elements are all designed to have adequate
strengths to resist the anticipated flexural yield mechanism of the frame.
6c.
Column
Size
(in.)
P n
at M = 0
(kips)
P b
(kips)
M b
(k-ft)
M n
at P = 0
(k-ft)
Interior
End
36x44
42x42
3,750
4,100
1,600
1,900
2,750
2,850
1,950
2,100
Columns must be designed for shear strength Ve required by 1921.4.5.1 and for
the special transverse reinforcement required by 1921.4.4.1. The design shear
force Ve shall be determined from the consideration of the maximum forces that
can be generated at the faces of the beam/column joints at the ends of beams
framing into the joint. These joint forces are determined in one of three methods:
1.
2.
The column shear Ve need not exceed that determined based on the probable
moment strength, M pr , of the beams framing into the joint.
3.
Ve shall not be less than the factored shear determined from analysis.
It is likely that the second method described above will control the shear design of
the column, since strong column behavior of the frame will force plastic hinges to
form in the beams. At the columns in the first story, the controlling case is from
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
301
Design Example 6
column top moments based on M pr of beams and column bottom moments based
on M pr of the column calculated with associated axial loads.
For the interior column, 36 44 , at stories one and two, the maximum shear need
be determined from maximum shear that can be transferred from beam strength,
M pr , as shown below.
Interior column at first story.
M pr
12'
M = 4,097 kip-ft 14' = 4,097 kip-ft
= 1,890 kip-ft
1
1
26'
14' 12'
The lower column could develop a maximum of M pr at its base. The moment
M pr for the column is determined with the PCA column program using a
reinforcement strength of 1.25 F y or 75 ksi. M pr determined with the PCA column
for an axial load of 1,000 kips is approximately 4,000 kip-ft.
The shear Ve is determined as follows based on clear column height
Ve =
This value is compared with frame analysis Vu = 176 kips, thus Ve controls.
302
Design Example 6
kip-ft
M col
4,605 kip ft
= 588 kips
7'10"
This value is compared with frame analysis Vu = 195 kips , thus Ve controls.
The tabulated calculation of column shears is shown in Table 6-14 below.
303
Design Example 6
2,3,4
Level/
Story
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
M pr +M pr
Col.
M pr
Clear (joint
(joint
at
Height above) above)
Joint
(ft)
(kip-ft) (kip-ft)
10
7.83
8.5
8.5
9
9
9
10
7.83
8.5
8.5
9
9
9
2,389
2,769
2,055
2,055
1,175
1,175
974
2,389
2,769
2,055
2,055
1,175
1,175
974
Dist
M pr
to
col.
M pr +M pr
M
M pr
at Col. (joint (joint
at
Top below) below)
Joint
(kip-ft) (kip-ft) (kip-ft)
to
col.
M
Ve
at Col. M
Bot. (kip-ft) at Col.
(kips )
(kip-ft)
4,000
1,285
1,385
1,028
1,028
588
588
4,000
2,204
2,399
1,745
1,745
899
1,104
2,670
2,412
2,055
1,615
1,175
1,562
1,893
4,603
4,144
3,490
2,644
1,798
510
341
284
242
179
131
174
589
588
487
411
294
200
899
2,496
277
Dist.
M pr
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1,708
2,028
1,435
1,435
623
623
2,389
2,769
2,055
2,055
1,175
1,175
974
4,097
4,797
3,490
3,490
1,798
1,798
0.462
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.5
1
0.462
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.5
1,104
1,385
1,028
1,028
588
588
974
1,893
2,399
1,745
1,745
899
899
0
2,389
2,769
2,055
2,055
1,175
1,175
0
2,389
2,769
2,055
2,055
1,175
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1,708
2,028
1,435
1,435
623
0
2,389
2,769
2,055
2,055
1,175
1,175
0
4,097
4,797
3,490
3,490
1,798
0.462
0.538
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.462
0.538
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.5
623
1,597
1,597
1,175
623
1,798
0.5
The total cross-section area of rectangular hoop reinforcement shall not be less than
that required by Equations (21-3) and (21-4).
Ash = 0.3 shc f ' c / f yh
)[(Ag
) ]
(21-3)
Ach 1
(21-4)
304
Design Example 6
Eq.
36x44 (21-3)
(21-4)
(21-3)
(21-4)
42x42 (21-3)
(21-4)
(21-3)
(21-4)
36
36
36
36
42
42
42
42
44
44
44
44
42
42
42
42
hc
Trans
hc
Long
32
32
40
40
38
38
38
38
f 'c
fy
Ag
Ach
Ash
4,000
4,000
4,000
4,000
4,000
4,000
4,000
4,000
60,000
60,000
60,000
60,000
60,000
60,000
60,000
60,000
1,584
1,390
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
0.357
0.768
0.446
0.96
0.397
0.912
0.397
0.912
1,584
1,764
1,764
1,390
1,560
1,560
No.
Legs
Size
Bars
#4
#4
#4
#4
Calculations for the required shear steel are shown in Table 6-16. The final column
design at the first level is summarized in Table 6-17. The column design may be
used for the full height columns or the reinforcement can be reduced slightly at the
upper portion of the frame. Since the longitudinal reinforcement is only
1.44 percent, the longitudinal reinforcement cannot be reduced below 1 percent in
any portion of the columns.
Col.
Shear Vu
(kips)
Shear Ve
(kips)
b
(in.)
d
(in.)
f 'c
(psi)
(psi)
36x44
42x42
195
140
510
589
36
42
44
42
4,000
4,000
60,000
60,000
Vc
Av
(kips) (sq. in.)
159
176
1.2
1.2
s
(in.)
Vs
(kips)
Vn
(kips)
DCR
4
4
627
597
786
773
0.65
0.76
Longitudinal
Reinforcement
Long. Stirrups
Within Yielding
Zones, l o
Long. Stirrups
Beyond Yielding
Zones, l o
Trans. Stirrups
wWthin Yielding
Zones, l o
Trans. Stirrups
Beyond Yielding
Zones, l o
36x44
42x42
18-#10
20-#10
6-#4@4"
6-#4@4"
6-#4@6"
6-#4@6"
5-#4@4"
6-#4@4"
5-#4@6"
6-#4@6"
Figures 6-10 and 6-11 show the column cross-section with dimensions and
reinforcement indicated.
Note: Crossties can have 90 degree and 135 degree bends at opposite ends. 90
degree bends should be alternated with 135 degree bends at each successive tie set
and at adjacent bars.
305
Design Example 6
306
Design Example 6
6d.
1633.1
The code requires that columns that are part of two or more intersection lateral
force resisting systems be analyzed for orthogonal effects. However, the code
excepts columns where the axial force caused by seismic forces from systems in
any direction is less than 20 percent of the column capacity (per 1633.1). In this
Design Example, the corner columns are required to be part of both the
longitudinal and transverse seismic frames. An analysis would indicate that these
columns fall below the 20 percent threshold and thus do not require an orthogonal
analysis.
7.
Beam-column joints of frames must be analyzed for joint shear in accordance with
1921.5. The shear forces from analysis and the joint strength are calculated in
Table 6-18.
8.
8a.
Location
Shear from
Analysis
(kips)
Vpr , Plastic
Shear
(kips)
Nominal
Shear Stress
Aj
(in.2)
Joint
Strength
(kips)
Result
s
Interior Beam
Level 3
155
253
15 f'c A j
1,320
1,064
o.k.
End Beam
Level 3
157
253
12 f'c A j
1,260
813
o.k.
Interior Column
Level 2
195
588
15 f'c A j
1,320
1,064
o.k.
End Column
Level 2
133
341
12 f'c A j
1,260
813
o.k.
Beam reinforcement.
Beams should be detailed with top, bottom and side reinforcement as shown in
Figure 6-7. In accordance with 1921.3.3, beam shear reinforcement, which meets
the spacing requirements of 1921.3.3.2, should be provided over a distance 2d
from the faces of columns. The tie spacing shall not exceed: 1.) d 4 ; 2.) 8d b of
minimum beam longitudinal bar diameters; 3.) 24d b of stirrup bars; and 4.) 12
inches. These requirements result in a 9-inch maximum tie spacing. However, from
analysis, ties required are #5 ties spaced at 6-inch centers. For ties between beam
hinge regions, ties are required at d 2 spacing. However, based on analysis # 5
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
307
Design Example 6
ties at 9-inch spacing are adequate across the remaining length of the beam (outside
the hinge areas at each end).
Longitudinal beam bars should be spliced away from the beam-column joints and a
minimum distance of 2h from the face of the columns, per 1921.3.2.3. At the
Level 2 beams for this Design Example, the beam clear spans are approximately
26 ft and 2h is 2(46") = 7 ft-8 in. The designer might consider splicing beam
longitudinal reinforcement at the quarter-, third-, or half-span locations. In this
case, the quarter-span locations would not be away from hinge regions. However,
the one-third, or mid-span, locations would also be okay. Increased shear
reinforcement is required at the lap splice locations per 1921.3.2.3. The maximum
spacing of ties in these regions shall not exceed d 4 or 4 inches. In this case, the
beam mid-point is the best place to locate the lap splices, which for the #11 top
bars at Class B splices would have a splice length of 110 inches or 7 ft-2 in. The
lap splice length for #9 bottom bars at a Class B lap splice is 69 inches or 5 ft-9 in.
Longitudinal reinforcement can be shipped in 60 ft-0 in. lengths on trucks, thus two
locations of longitudinal beam lap splices would be required in the frame along
Line A, conceivably on the two interior spans.
8b.
Column reinforcement.
Column splices should occur at column mid-story heights (or within the center half
of the column heights) per 1921.4.3.2. Special transverse reinforcement is
required per 1921.4.4 over a length l o above and below beams at spacing not
greater than: 1.) the column depth; 2.) one-sixth the column clear span; or 3.) a
maximum of 18 inches. For this Design Example the column depth would control
which is either 42 inches or 44 inches depending on the column. For column
sections between the locations where special transverse reinforcement is required,
the spacing requirements of 1907.10.5.2 apply where ties should be spaced a
maximum of 16 longitudinal bar diameters, 48 tie bar diameters or the least
dimension of the column. This would require ties at 20 inches; however for this
Design Example, it is recommended not to space column tie bars greater than 6
inches per 1921.4.4.6 and 4 inches at lap splices.
9.
Foundation considerations.
Design Example 6
309
Design Example 6
310
Design Example 6
Commentary
Deformation compatibility should be checked at interior columns due to seismic
drifts M . This will lead to a conservative design for punching shear at
slab/column joints. These joints may require drop panels or shear head
reinforcement in the slab over interior columns.
The building period in this Design Example was calculated using Method A.
Method B could be used as long as the resulting period was not more than
130 percent of the Method A period (in Seismic Zone 4) or 140 percent of the
Method A period (in Seismic Zones 1, 2, and 3). If Method B is used to determine
the period, the designer should keep in mind that nonseismic elements can cause
stiffness in the building and thus cause a decrease to the Method B period
determination. Thus, interior nonseismic columns or other important stiffening
elements should be included in Method B period calculations to ensure
conservative period calculation results.
Reinforced concrete SMRF frames can provide very ductile seismic systems for
buildings with highly desirable performance characteristics. The yielding
mechanisms can be predicted and the seismic performance will be ductile and not
brittle. Care should be taken to ensure adequate shear strength at beams, columns,
and joints, so that ductile flexural yielding will occur as anticipated. Care should
also be taken with lap splices and detailing of reinforcement and with specified
couplers. Reinforcement should be ASTM-A706, which has more ductile
performance characteristics that ASTM-A615 reinforcement.
311
Design Example 6
References
A. H. Nilson and G. Winter, 1986. Design of Concrete Structures, Tenth Edition.
McGraw-Hill, New York.
ATC-40, 1996. Seismic Evaluation and Retrofit of Concrete Buildings. Applied
Technology Council, Redwood City, California.
J. C. McCormac, Design of Reinforced Concrete. Third Edition. Harper-Collins, New
York.
J. G. MacGregor, 1992. Reinforced Concrete Mechanics and Design, Second Edition.
Prentice Hall, New Jersey.
R. Park and T. Paulay, 1975. Reinforced Concrete Structures. John Wiley and Sons,
New York.
Paulay, T. and Priestley, N.J., 1992. Seismic Design of Reinforced Concrete and
Masonry Buildings. John Wiley and Sons, New York.
312
Design Example 7
Design Example 7
Precast Concrete Cladding
front elevation
Overview
This Design Example illustrates the seismic design of precast concrete cladding
Panels A and B shown in the partial wall elevation of Figure 7-1. This cladding
example is for a 4-story steel moment frame structure located in Seismic Zone 4.
The architect has chosen precast concrete panels for the faade.
Current standard practice is to specify that the fabricator perform the design for the
panel and connections. The structural Engineer of Record for the building typically
reviews the fabricators design for compliance with the project design
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
313
Design Example 7
specifications, and for compatibility with the structural framing. It is important that
the structural Engineer of Record understand that panel loads are concentrated at
discrete points to the structure. These points of attachment will usually require
additional support steel to reach the panel connection hardware. These supports
will typically induce eccentric loads into the beams and columns that must be
accounted for in design of the structure. Wind loads will also be considered in this
example, since some elements of the connection and panel reinforcing may be
controlled by wind, while seismic forces may control other parts.
Earthquake-damaged cladding can become a severe falling hazard, particularly
damaged cladding on highrise buildings in congested urban areas. Cladding is
typically connected at a few discrete points, which limit the redundancy of the
system. For this reason, code seismic requirements for the attachment of
cladding require a more conservative design than other building components.
Building cladding is also required to resist realistic story drifts without failure
through flexible connections and adequate panel joints. These requirements are
detailed in 1633.2.4.2 and will be illustrated in this Design Example.
This Design Example provides an overview of the design procedure for precast
concrete cladding panels and their connections to the structure.
Outline
This Design Example illustrates the following parts of the design process:
314
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Connection forces.
6.
7.
8.
Design Example 7
Given Information
Exterior wall system weight:
Precast concrete panel (5 thickness) = 62.5 psf
Window system = 10 psf
Metal stud and gypsum board, 5 psf
Wind design data:
Basic wind speed = 70 mph
Wind exposure = C
Importance factor, Iw = 1.0
Seismic design data:
Occupancy category: standard occupancy structure
Seismic importance factor, Ip = 1.0
Soil profile type: stiff soil type SD (default profile)
Seismic zone 4, Z=0.4
Near-source factors:
Seismic source type A
Distance to seismic source, 7 km
Maximum inelastic response displacement, M = 3.2 in.
Building design data:
Building mean roof height = 64 ft
Top of parapet = elevation 66 ft 6 in.
Building plan dimensions = 150 ft x 70 ft
Material specifications:
Concrete:
Compressive strength fc = 4,000 psi, ASTM C39
Aggregates, ASTM C33
Portland Cement, ASTM C150
Admixtures, ASTM C494
Unit weight 150 pcf, ASTM C138
Steel:
Structural shapes, plates and bars Fy = 36 ksi, ASTM A36
Hollow structural section: round Fy = 33 ksi, ASTM A53, Grade B
Hollow structural section: rectangular Fy = 46 ksi, ASTM A500, Grade B
Welded Reinforcing steel fy = 60 ksi, ASTM A706
Non-welded reinforcing steel fy= 60 ksi, ASTM A615, Grade 60
Coil rods, ASTM A108
Weld electrodes:
Shielded metal arc welding FEXX = 70 ksi, AWS A5.1 E70XX
Flux-cored arc welding FEXX = 70 ksi, AWS A5.20 E7XT
315
Design Example 7
1.
Code Reference
1605.1
Cladding panels must be designed to resist both vertical loads and lateral forces.
Typically the vertical loads consist of the panel weight and the weight of any
windows or other miscellaneous architectural items attached to the panel.
Normally, two bearings points are provided and the panel is treated as a simply
supported beam for vertical loads. The lateral forces consist of both wind and
seismic effects. Wind forces are included in this Design Example because they are
an integral part of the design process for cladding and to illustrate the application
of load combinations for all the loading cases.
Where structural effects of creep, shrinkage, and temperature change may be
significant in the design, they shall be included in the load combinations.
1a.
1909.2.7
Wind pressures are determined from Equation (20-1) using the 70 mph basic wind
speed. This process is shown below.
(20-1)
P = Ce Cq qs Iw
qs = 12.6 psf
Table 16-F
Table 16-G
The pressure coefficients for the exterior elements are given in Table 16-H. The
resulting pressures are summarized in Table 7-1 below.
316
Design Example 7
Direction
Cq
p (psf)
In
1.2
21.92
Out
1.2
21.92
Out
1.5
27.41
In
1.2
21.92
In/out
1.3
23.91
1b.
1632
Seismic forces for elements of structures, such as the precast panels of this
example, are specified in 1632. These are summarized below.
panel
in-plane
out-of-plane
(32-1)
This represents an upper bound of element force levels and is seldom used.
The alternate equation, more frequently used is:
Fp =
a p Ca I p
h
1 + 3 x W p
Rp
hr
(32-2)
317
Design Example 7
Limits are set on Equation (32-2) such that Fp shall not be less than 0.7 CaIpWp and
need not be more than 4 CaIpWp.
(32-3)
Typically the alternate Equation (32-2) is used since the results for panel and body
loads will be more in line with the previous code force levels.
Pertinent values for ap and Rp , taken from Table 16-O, are given below in
Table 7-2.
ap
Rp
2.5
3.0
1.0
3.0
1.0
3.0
The structural Engineer of Record must specify the near-source factor and distance
to the fault zone. In many cases the seismic coefficient Ca is specified, but for this
example we will start with Na and the fault distance.
The seismic coefficient Ca is found from Table 16-Q.
For seismic zone 4 and soil profile type Sd
Ca = 0.44 Na
Table 16-Q
Since the distance to the source is 7 km and the source is type A, Na is found by
interpolation as permitted by Table 16-S.
Na =
318
Design Example 7
Minimum
At hx :
Fp =
(1.0)(0.493)(1.0) 1 + 3 hx = 0.164 1 +
3.0
64
hx
21.33
Rp = 3.0
Rp = 1.0
Table 7-3 below summarizes the seismic coefficients, which multiplied by the
tributary weight Wp, are used to determine the design lateral force Fp. Note that the
seismic coefficients for the fasteners are substantially higher than those for the
panel or the body of the connection. Use of these is illustrated later in this example.
hx/hr
Fp (panel)
Fp (body)
Fp (fastener)
0.00
0.345
0.345
0.493
0.25
0.345
0.345
0.862
0.50
0.411
0.411
1.232
0.75
0.534
0.534
1.602
1.00
0.657
0.657
1.970
Parapet
1.00
1.643
1.643
1.970
In this Design Example, the floor elevation where the upper connections are
attached was used to calculate Fp. For out-of-plane forces, this is conservative since
the other connections are below this point. For in-plane forces this would follow
the current interpretation since all primary reactions occur at this level.
SEAOC Seismic Design Manual, Vol. III (1997 UBC)
319
Design Example 7
2.
In general the final precast design begins with the panel thickness as a fixed
dimension and the connection system is developed from that point forward. The
panel thickness is a decision that must be made early in the design process by the
architect. Consultation with a precast manufacturer is recommended to help with
shipping and handling considerations. Any changes to the panel thickness after the
project has proceeded can have significant impact on other portions of work.
There are many factors to consider when deciding on a panel thickness. Some of
these are listed below:
Architectural considerations:
Fire resistance
Thermal insulation
Sound insulation
Weather resistance
Structural considerations:
Total weight of exterior elements
Weight supported by exterior beams and columns
Deflection and cracking
Fabrication and installation:
Minimum weight for handling, shipping and erection
Adequate thickness for efficient handling
Adequate stiffness for an efficient connection scheme
For this project, the panels are specified to be 5 inches thick. This thickness
provides adequate anchorage depth for the connection hardware and also allows the
panel to be handled easily. Another consideration is the warping and bowing that
may occur during curing. Thin long panels will bow or warp more than thick short
panels.
3.
320
Design Example 7
resists forces in
all directions
resists out-of-plane
forces only
1.5 ft, typ
27 ft
The tributary height is 16 ft because the precast panels transfer wind load on both
the glazing and panels to the structure.
Total uniform wind loading on panel.
pw = 21.92 psf (16 ft) = 351 plf
Assume the panel under consideration is located on Level 3. The working level
load for the seismic forces is:
ps =
Fp
1.4
wp =
0.534
[(62.5 psf )(7 ft ) + (10 psf )(9 ft )] = 201.1 plf
1.4
Therefore, wind controls for panel design. This is typical for a spandrel panel.
Check panel moment at mid-span.
2
(9-9)
This panel stress is well above the modulus of rupture and the panel will not satisfy
the deflection criteria because of the reduced moment of inertia from cracking
(1909.5.2.3).
321
Design Example 7
Although the code does not specifically address out-of -plane deflection of
cladding panels, some guidance can be found in Table 16A-W of the 1998
California Building Code. Typically, the deflection is limited to L/240 because of
the other elements that are attached. Also, in order to satisfy the crack control
criteria of the code (See 1910.6.4), large amounts of reinforcing may be required.
Consequently, connections will be provided at mid-span to reduce the panel
stresses and deflections.
4.
Panel design.
Wind controls the panel design and bending moments are determined using the
load combination of Equation (12-6). Note that the 1.1 multiplier of Exception 2 of
1612.2.1 is not applied for wind.
Wind:
M f = pw
l2
27'
= 13.5'
= 8.0 k-ft where l =
8
2
Mc
Mu 1
M c = pw
a
= 0.39 k-ft where a = 1.5'
2
Mu 2
centerline
1M
d = 2"
M n = As f y d
2
a=
As f y
0.85 f cb
Design Example 7
1914.3.3
3 f c
fy
bw d =
3 4000
(12")(2") = 0.076 in.2/ft
60,000
1910.5
(10-3)
b =
87,000 + f y
f
y
0.85 (0.85)(4 )
87,000
=
= 0.0285
60
87,000 + 60,000
(8-1)
1910.6.4
M wind =
7.8 k ft
= 1.1 k-ft/ft
7
f by =
M wind 1.11(12")
=
= 0.267 ksi
Sy
50.0
Sx =
hb 2 5(84 )2
=
= 5,880 in.3
6
6
323
Design Example 7
M DL 48.1(12")
=
= 0.098 ksi
Sx
5,880
13.5' (12 )
L
=
= 0.675"
240
240
o.k.
Deflection is o.k.
5.
Connection forces.
In this part, connection forces will be determined. Seismic forces are determined
for a 1g loading. These will then be appropriately scaled in Part 6. The distribution
factors used to determine reactions at the various supports were determined from a
generic moment distribution. For brevity, that analysis is not shown here.
Element weights:
324
Panel A
= 13.13 k
x = 15 ft
z = .208 ft
Column cover B
= 1.125 k
x = 1 ft
z = .208 ft
Column cover B
= 1.125 k
x = 29 ft
z = .208 ft
Window
= 2.34 k
x = 15 ft
z = .10 ft
Total
Wtot =
= 17.72 k
x = 15 ft
z = .19 ft
Design Example 7
Gravity.
For gravity loads, the panel is treated as a simply supported beam using two
bearing connections to support the vertical load. Since the vertical support reaction
does not line up with the center of gravity in the z-direction, additional reactions
are necessary in the z-direction to maintain equilibrium, as shown in Figure 7-4.
ez = 0.33 ft (distance from the back of the panel to the center of the bearing bolt)
R1y = 17.72/2 = 8.86 k
R1z = 8.86 (0.19 + 0.33)/5.25 = .88 k
R3z = -R1z
y
ez
y
R1y
R1z
x
R3z
z
Seismic out-of-plane ( 1g ).
Connection distribution factors for a uniform load applied to a symmetric two span
continuous beam with cantilevers at the ends are shown below and are used to
distribute the uniform panel weight applied transverse to the panel. These can be
found by moment distribution or other suitable means of continuous beam analysis.
DFe = 0.223 (fraction of total load resisted by outside support)
DFm = 0.554 (fraction of total load resisted by mid-span support)
Connection distribution factors for a uniform load applied to a symmetric two span
continuous beam without cantilevers at the end are given below. These will be used
to distribute the uniform window load to the connections.
DFe = 0.1875 (fraction of total load resisted by exterior support)
DFm = 0.625 (fraction of total load resisted by middle support)
325
Design Example 7
2.75 ft
R5z
R1z
2.50 ft
x
R3z
R6z
In-plane seismic forces (Figure 7-6) are typically resisted by connections at the
level the panel is supported. Overturning forces are resisted by vertical reactions at
the supports.
el = 0.50 ft
R1x = 17.72/3 = 5.91 k
R1y = 17.72 k (2.75'/27') = 1.80 k
R1z = 1.80 k (.19 +.33)/5.25' + 17.72 k (.19 + .5)/27' = 0.63 k
y
el
y
R2x
R1x
R5x
R1z
R1y
R3z
x
R2y
Design Example 7
Wind loading.
The distribution of total load is similar as was done for seismic out-of-plane forces
(Figure 7-5).
Pw = 21.92 psf (16')(30') = 10.52 k
R1z = [(0.223)(10.52 k)](2.5'/5.25') = 1.12 k
R3z = [(0.223)(10.52 k)](2.75'/5.25') = 1.23 k
R5z = [(0.554)(10.52 k)](2.5'/5.25') = 2.78 k
R6z = [(0.554)(10.52 k)](2.75'/5.25') = 3.05 k
6.
Connection design.
Design of the bearing connection will be done using strength design for both
concrete and steel elements of the connection. This is illustrated in the parts below.
6a.
The basic load combinations are defined in 1612.2.1. Normally there are no floor
live loads, roof live loads, or snow loads on cladding panels. The load
combinations of Equations (12-1) through (12-6) reduce to the following. Parts of
the load combinations not used have a strike line through them.
1.4D
(12-1)
(12-2)
(12-3)
(12-4)
(12-5)
(12-6)
327
Design Example 7
1.4D + 1.7 L
(9-1)
(9-2)
0.9D + 1.3 W
(9-3)
1.1(1.2D + 1.0E)
(12-5)
(12-6)
For concrete anchors, additional load factors can be found in 1923.2. A load
factor of 1.3 is normally applied for panel anchorage when special inspection is
provided. When special inspection is not provided, a factor of 2 is applied. In
addition, when anchors are embedded in the tension zone of a member, an anchor
factor of 2 is required for special inspection and an anchor factor of 3 is required
for no special inspection. These factors are not considered applicable to cladding
panels, since the connector load is already raised significantly for nonductile
portions of the connector.
It should be noted that 1632.2 requires the design of shallow anchors to be based
on forces using a response modification factor, Rp , of 1.5. Most embedded anchors
in panels fall within the shallow anchor criteria. Since the fastener force is based on
an Rp equal to 1.0, the shallow anchor requirement is superceded by the more
stringent fastener force requirement.
The total seismic force is defined as follows, where Fp is used for Eh and Ev is
defined in 1630.1.1:
E = Eh + Ev
(30-1)
Ev = 0.5 Ca I D
1630.1.1
Under 1632.2, the reliability/redundancy factor, , may be taken equal to 1.0 for
component design.
The 1997 UBC load factors do not distinguish between members of the lateral
force-resisting system and components, as the 1994 UBC did. Therefore, wording
in the 1997 code is such that Ev should be considered for strength design of
components similar to the requirements for the structure design. Ev was added to
the code to make the load factors consistent with the load combination
1.4 (D + L + E), which applied to lateral force-resisting systems. For component
design, the normal ACI and AISC load factors were appropriate, and hence no
inconsistency was created. The addition of Ev for component design creates a
higher load factor on dead load when compared to the 1994 UBC requirements.
328
Design Example 7
X-Direction
Body Force
Y-Direction
Z-Direction
0.00
0.00
3.17
0.00
0.00
8.86
0.00
0.96
0.00
0.00
0.88
1.17
0.34
1.12
1.12
Fastener Force
X-Direction
Y-Direction
Z-Direction
0.00
0.00
9.48
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
13.56
-13.56
0.00
0.00
12.40
12.82
7.97
13.78
7.01
10.63
7.97
1.23
2.44
-0.38
1.61
0.45
2.51
-0.66
0.00
0.00
0.00
9.48
-9.48
0.00
0.00
8.86
0.00
2.88
0.00
0.00
Anchor Factor =
16.13
18.33
11.40
22.45
7.28
12.09
10.37
12.40
12.82
7.97
15.70
5.09
10.63
7.97
0.88
3.51
1.02
1.12
1.12
1.3 (2)
1.60
6.84
-3.89
3.28
- 0.33
3.06
-0.83
1.23
4.78
-2.72
2.29
- 0.23
2.51
-0.66
Notes:
1. D = dead load
Et = seismic out-of-plane
El = seismic in-plane
Wo = wind out
Wi = wind in
2. From 1923.3, assuming special inspection.
329
Design Example 7
6b.
A typical bearing support is illustrated below and is used in this example to outline
the design procedure for a panel connection. Most cladding panels use a threaded
bolt to support the gravity loads. The bolt can be turned to adjust the panel into its
final position. The embed is usually an angle with a threaded hole oriented as
shown is Figure 7-7. This provides a low profile that can be hidden within the
interior finishes.
2206
Make preliminary selection of angle thickness. Note the critical section occurs at
the root of the fillet or a distance k from the heel of the angle.
M u = Rvu (e k ) = 13.78 (4 1.5) = 34.45 k-in.
330
Design Example 7
4 Mu
= 0.73"
fy b
Use t = 1.0"
Try L6 6 1 0' 8"
The body of connection forces for the load combination of 1.45 D + 1.0 El are
shown below. Note that the moment is determined at the k-distance (see p. 1-58 of
AISCLRFD Manual).
Muy = Ry1 (e1 k) = 13.78 (41.5) = 34.45 k-in.
Mux = Rx1 (e2 k) = 3.16 (61.5) = 14.22 k-in.
Pu = 1.61 k
M ny
M nx = f y Z x =
o.k.
Use L6 6 1 0'8"
6c.
Anchorage to concrete.
1923
The concrete anchors consist of flat bar metal straps bent in a U-shape and welded
to the back of the angle, as shown in Figures 7-8 and 7-9. Reinforcing bars are then
placed in the inside corners of the bends to effectively transfer the anchor forces
into the concrete. By doing this, the strength reduction factor, , may be taken as
0.85 instead of 0.65 per 1923.3.2.
331
Design Example 7
Headed studs are also used to transfer the forces to the concrete. The pull-out
calculation for design is similar to the procedure for bent straps.
le
le
le
bs
le
le
bs
le
1923.3.2
Find the pull-out capacity of one leg of a 2 in. x 5/16 in. flat bar using the projected
area of the shear cone.
bs = 2 in.
ts = 0.3125 in.
le = l ts = 4 0.3125 = 3.69 in.
A p = 2l e bs + l e 2 = 57.54 in.2
Pnc1 = 4 A p
Find the pull-out capacity of both legs of the 2-inch x5/16-inch flat bar using the
projected area of the shear cone.
Width w = 8 2 (1/2) 0.3125 = 6.69 in.
A p 2 = 2l e bs + l e 2 + 2l e w = 106.9 in.
Pnc 2 = 4 A p
f c = 0.85 (1.0 )(4 )(106.9 ) 4,000 / 1,000 = 22.9 k < 2Pc1 = 24.75
Pc 2 controls
332
Design Example 7
dy
el
Cu
a/2
Tu1
a/2
Rtu
Cu
d
ez
Rvu
Tu2
Rxu
a=
Pnc
22.9
=
= 0.84 in.
0.85 f cb 0.85 (4 )(8)
Tu 2 =
o.k.
Tu1 =
(R xu )(e1 ) R zu
+
(d a / 2) 2
Cu min
(13.56)(6) + ( 0.33) 1 (7.28)(4) = 8.56 k < P o.k.
=
c1
(7.34 0.5)
2
2
2 (5 0.4 )
Use reinforcing steel to resist vertical and horizontal shear forces. Computations of
required reinforcement is shown below.
Asv =
R yu
f y
22.45
= 0.32 in.2
(1.3)(0.9)(60 ksi )
Rxu
13.56
=
= 0.19 in.2
f y (1.3)(0.9 )(60 ksi )
333
Design Example 7
6d.
Rzu/2
2 in.
Rzu/2
1 R zu 1 4.78
=
= 0.80 k/in. shear component
2 lw
2 3
ft =
1 Rzu e 1 4.78(2 / 2 )
=
= 1.59 k/in. tension component
2 Sw
2 32 / 6
fr =
o.k.
334
Design Example 7
In-plane forces.
R xu 9.48
=
= 2.37 k/in.
lw
4
ft =
1 R xu e 1 9.48(2)
=
= 3.55 k/in.
2 Sw
2 42 / 6
fr =
f v 2 + f t 2 = 4.27 k/in.
Rnw = t eff 0.6 FEXX = 0.75(0.707 )(0.25)(0.6 )70 ksi = 5.57 k/in. > fr
o.k.
7.
Drift analysis.
1633.2.4.2(1)
One of the most important aspects of cladding design is to ensure that the panel
connections and joints allow for the interstory drift that occurs as a result of lateral
deflection of the frame from wind, seismic loads, temperature, and shrinkage
forces. For most structures in Seismic Zones 3 and 4, seismic drift will control.
For seismic drift, all cladding elements must accommodate the maximum inelastic
story drift (M) that is expected for the design basis earthquake forces. The 1994
UBC estimated the inelastic drift as 3/8(Rw) times the calculated elastic story drift
caused by design seismic forces. Now the inelastic drift is computed as 0.7 RS per
1630.9.2 or by a more detailed analysis. A comparison of the two values is shown
below:
335
Design Example 7
1994 UBC
M =
R
M = 0.7 R s 0.7 w 1.4 0.7 Rw
1.4
3
Rw
8
1997 UBC
0.04
h
Rw
3
0.04h
Rw
0.015 h
Rw
8
If T 0.7 sec ,
M =
0.03
h
Rw
3
0.03h
Rw
0.01125h
8
Rw
The maximum inelastic drift can be as much as 78 percent higher under the
provisions of the 1997 UBC compared to that calculated under the 1994 UBC. This
can have a major impact on the cladding elements and must be considered early in
the planning process. Fortunately, the majority of structures have drift less than the
maximum.
It is also important to coordinate the mechanism by which this drift is
accommodated with other elements and components of the cladding system, such
as the window system.
Drift requirements are:
1.
2(wind )
2.
M = 3.2 in.
3.
1633.2.4.2 (1)
Infill panels, such as the column cover (Panel B), require special review when it
comes to movement. Typical these panels are attached to other elements and see
the full story drift, but the height over which this movement occurs is much less
than the story height. Therefore, the rotation that the panel undergoes can be more
than two times the rotation of the column.
336
Design Example 7
hc
pivot point
wc
337
Design Example 7
As the beam hinge location moves toward the interior, the spandrel panel can also
experience up and down movement at each support point.
= M / hs = 3.2"/(16')(12') = 0.01667 radians
v = xb = 0.01667 rad (18") = 0.30 in.
Differential displacements out-of-plane of the panel should also be considered.
8.
Typical details.
338
Design Example 7
References
Iverson, James K. and Hawkins, Neil M., 1994. Performance of Precast/Prestressed
Concrete Building Structures During Northridge Earthquake, PCI Journal,
Vol. 39.
McCann, R.A., 1991. Architectural Precast Concrete Cladding Connections,
Implementation and Performance of Structural Details, 1991 Fall Seminar,
Session 2, Structural Engineers Association of Northern California.
PCI, 1999. PCI Design Handbook Precast and Prestressed Concrete, 5th edition.
Precast/Prestressed Concrete Institute, Chicago Illinois.
Sheppard, D. A. and Phillips, W. R., 1989. Plant Cast Precast and Prestressed
Concrete: A Design Guide,3rd edition. McGraw-Hill, New York, New York.
339
Design Example 7
340